Quotations.ch
  Directory : Treasure Island
GUIDE SUPPORT US BLOG
  • The Project Gutenberg EBook of Treasure Island, by Robert Louis Stevenson
  • This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
  • almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
  • re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
  • with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
  • Title: Treasure Island
  • Author: Robert Louis Stevenson
  • Release Date: February 25, 2006 [EBook #120]
  • Last Updated: June 11, 2019
  • Language: English
  • Character set encoding: UTF-8
  • *** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TREASURE ISLAND ***
  • Produced by Judy Boss, John Hamm and David Widger
  • TREASURE ISLAND
  • by Robert Louis Stevenson
  • TREASURE ISLAND
  • To S.L.O., an American gentleman in accordance with whose classic taste
  • the following narrative has been designed, it is now, in return for
  • numerous delightful hours, and with the kindest wishes, dedicated by his
  • affectionate friend, the author.
  • TO THE HESITATING PURCHASER
  • If sailor tales to sailor tunes,
  • Storm and adventure, heat and cold,
  • If schooners, islands, and maroons,
  • And buccaneers, and buried gold,
  • And all the old romance, retold
  • Exactly in the ancient way,
  • Can please, as me they pleased of old,
  • The wiser youngsters of today:
  • --So be it, and fall on! If not,
  • If studious youth no longer crave,
  • His ancient appetites forgot,
  • Kingston, or Ballantyne the brave,
  • Or Cooper of the wood and wave:
  • So be it, also! And may I
  • And all my pirates share the grave
  • Where these and their creations lie!
  • CONTENTS
  • PART ONE
  • The Old Buccaneer
  • 1. THE OLD SEA-DOG AT THE ADMIRAL BENBOW 11
  • 2. BLACK DOG APPEARS AND DISAPPEARS . . . . 17
  • 3. THE BLACK SPOT . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
  • 4. THE SEA-CHEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
  • 5. THE LAST OF THE BLIND MAN . . . . . . . 36
  • 6. THE CAPTAIN'S PAPERS . . . . . . . . . . 41
  • PART TWO
  • The Sea Cook
  • 7. I GO TO BRISTOL . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
  • 8. AT THE SIGN OF THE SPY-GLASS . . . . . . . 54
  • 9. POWDER AND ARMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
  • 10. THE VOYAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
  • 11. WHAT I HEARD IN THE APPLE BARREL . . . . 70
  • 12. COUNCIL OF WAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
  • PART THREE
  • My Shore Adventure
  • 13. HOW MY SHORE ADVENTURE BEGAN . . . . . . 82
  • 14. THE FIRST BLOW . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
  • 15. THE MAN OF THE ISLAND. . . . . . . . . . 93
  • PART FOUR
  • The Stockade
  • 16. NARRATIVE CONTINUED BY THE DOCTOR:
  • HOW THE SHIP WAS ABANDONED . . . . . . 100
  • 17. NARRATIVE CONTINUED BY THE DOCTOR:
  • THE JOLLY-BOAT'S LAST TRIP . . . . . . 105
  • 18. NARRATIVE CONTINUED BY THE DOCTOR:
  • END OF THE FIRST DAY'S FIGHTING . . . 109
  • 19. NARRATIVE RESUMED BY JIM HAWKINS:
  • THE GARRISON IN THE STOCKADE . . . . . 114
  • 20. SILVER'S EMBASSY . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
  • 21. THE ATTACK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
  • PART FIVE
  • My Sea Adventure
  • 22. HOW MY SEA ADVENTURE BEGAN . . . . . . . 132
  • 23. THE EBB-TIDE RUNS . . . . . . . . . . . 138
  • 24. THE CRUISE OF THE CORACLE . . . . . . . 143
  • 25. I STRIKE THE JOLLY ROGER . . . . . . . . 148
  • 26. ISRAEL HANDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
  • 27. “PIECES OF EIGHT” . . . . . . . . . . . 161
  • PART SIX
  • Captain Silver
  • 28. IN THE ENEMY'S CAMP . . . . . . . . . . 168
  • 29. THE BLACK SPOT AGAIN . . . . . . . . . . 176
  • 30. ON PAROLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
  • 31. THE TREASURE-HUNT--FLINT'S POINTER . . . 189
  • 32. THE TREASURE-HUNT--THE VOICE AMONG
  • THE TREES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
  • 33. THE FALL OF A CHIEFTAIN . . . . . . . . 201
  • 34. AND LAST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
  • TREASURE ISLAND
  • PART ONE--The Old Buccaneer
  • 1
  • The Old Sea-dog at the Admiral Benbow
  • SQUIRE TRELAWNEY, Dr. Livesey, and the rest of these gentlemen having
  • asked me to write down the whole particulars about Treasure Island, from
  • the beginning to the end, keeping nothing back but the bearings of the
  • island, and that only because there is still treasure not yet lifted, I
  • take up my pen in the year of grace 17__ and go back to the time when
  • my father kept the Admiral Benbow inn and the brown old seaman with the
  • sabre cut first took up his lodging under our roof.
  • I remember him as if it were yesterday, as he came plodding to the
  • inn door, his sea-chest following behind him in a hand-barrow--a
  • tall, strong, heavy, nut-brown man, his tarry pigtail falling over the
  • shoulder of his soiled blue coat, his hands ragged and scarred, with
  • black, broken nails, and the sabre cut across one cheek, a dirty, livid
  • white. I remember him looking round the cover and whistling to himself
  • as he did so, and then breaking out in that old sea-song that he sang so
  • often afterwards:
  • “Fifteen men on the dead man's chest--
  • Yo-ho-ho, and a bottle of rum!”
  • in the high, old tottering voice that seemed to have been tuned and
  • broken at the capstan bars. Then he rapped on the door with a bit of
  • stick like a handspike that he carried, and when my father appeared,
  • called roughly for a glass of rum. This, when it was brought to him,
  • he drank slowly, like a connoisseur, lingering on the taste and still
  • looking about him at the cliffs and up at our signboard.
  • “This is a handy cove,” says he at length; “and a pleasant sittyated
  • grog-shop. Much company, mate?”
  • My father told him no, very little company, the more was the pity.
  • “Well, then,” said he, “this is the berth for me. Here you, matey,” he
  • cried to the man who trundled the barrow; “bring up alongside and help
  • up my chest. I'll stay here a bit,” he continued. “I'm a plain man; rum
  • and bacon and eggs is what I want, and that head up there for to watch
  • ships off. What you mought call me? You mought call me captain. Oh, I
  • see what you're at--there”; and he threw down three or four gold pieces
  • on the threshold. “You can tell me when I've worked through that,” says
  • he, looking as fierce as a commander.
  • And indeed bad as his clothes were and coarsely as he spoke, he had none
  • of the appearance of a man who sailed before the mast, but seemed like
  • a mate or skipper accustomed to be obeyed or to strike. The man who came
  • with the barrow told us the mail had set him down the morning before at
  • the Royal George, that he had inquired what inns there were along the
  • coast, and hearing ours well spoken of, I suppose, and described as
  • lonely, had chosen it from the others for his place of residence. And
  • that was all we could learn of our guest.
  • He was a very silent man by custom. All day he hung round the cove or
  • upon the cliffs with a brass telescope; all evening he sat in a corner
  • of the parlour next the fire and drank rum and water very strong. Mostly
  • he would not speak when spoken to, only look up sudden and fierce and
  • blow through his nose like a fog-horn; and we and the people who came
  • about our house soon learned to let him be. Every day when he came back
  • from his stroll he would ask if any seafaring men had gone by along the
  • road. At first we thought it was the want of company of his own kind
  • that made him ask this question, but at last we began to see he was
  • desirous to avoid them. When a seaman did put up at the Admiral Benbow
  • (as now and then some did, making by the coast road for Bristol) he
  • would look in at him through the curtained door before he entered the
  • parlour; and he was always sure to be as silent as a mouse when any such
  • was present. For me, at least, there was no secret about the matter, for
  • I was, in a way, a sharer in his alarms. He had taken me aside one day
  • and promised me a silver fourpenny on the first of every month if I
  • would only keep my “weather-eye open for a seafaring man with one leg”
  • and let him know the moment he appeared. Often enough when the first
  • of the month came round and I applied to him for my wage, he would only
  • blow through his nose at me and stare me down, but before the week was
  • out he was sure to think better of it, bring me my four-penny piece, and
  • repeat his orders to look out for “the seafaring man with one leg.”
  • How that personage haunted my dreams, I need scarcely tell you. On
  • stormy nights, when the wind shook the four corners of the house and
  • the surf roared along the cove and up the cliffs, I would see him in a
  • thousand forms, and with a thousand diabolical expressions. Now the leg
  • would be cut off at the knee, now at the hip; now he was a monstrous
  • kind of a creature who had never had but the one leg, and that in the
  • middle of his body. To see him leap and run and pursue me over hedge and
  • ditch was the worst of nightmares. And altogether I paid pretty dear for
  • my monthly fourpenny piece, in the shape of these abominable fancies.
  • But though I was so terrified by the idea of the seafaring man with one
  • leg, I was far less afraid of the captain himself than anybody else who
  • knew him. There were nights when he took a deal more rum and water
  • than his head would carry; and then he would sometimes sit and sing his
  • wicked, old, wild sea-songs, minding nobody; but sometimes he would call
  • for glasses round and force all the trembling company to listen to his
  • stories or bear a chorus to his singing. Often I have heard the house
  • shaking with “Yo-ho-ho, and a bottle of rum,” all the neighbours joining
  • in for dear life, with the fear of death upon them, and each singing
  • louder than the other to avoid remark. For in these fits he was the most
  • overriding companion ever known; he would slap his hand on the table for
  • silence all round; he would fly up in a passion of anger at a question,
  • or sometimes because none was put, and so he judged the company was not
  • following his story. Nor would he allow anyone to leave the inn till he
  • had drunk himself sleepy and reeled off to bed.
  • His stories were what frightened people worst of all. Dreadful stories
  • they were--about hanging, and walking the plank, and storms at sea, and
  • the Dry Tortugas, and wild deeds and places on the Spanish Main. By his
  • own account he must have lived his life among some of the wickedest men
  • that God ever allowed upon the sea, and the language in which he told
  • these stories shocked our plain country people almost as much as the
  • crimes that he described. My father was always saying the inn would be
  • ruined, for people would soon cease coming there to be tyrannized over
  • and put down, and sent shivering to their beds; but I really believe his
  • presence did us good. People were frightened at the time, but on looking
  • back they rather liked it; it was a fine excitement in a quiet country
  • life, and there was even a party of the younger men who pretended to
  • admire him, calling him a “true sea-dog” and a “real old salt” and
  • such like names, and saying there was the sort of man that made England
  • terrible at sea.
  • In one way, indeed, he bade fair to ruin us, for he kept on staying week
  • after week, and at last month after month, so that all the money had
  • been long exhausted, and still my father never plucked up the heart to
  • insist on having more. If ever he mentioned it, the captain blew through
  • his nose so loudly that you might say he roared, and stared my poor
  • father out of the room. I have seen him wringing his hands after such a
  • rebuff, and I am sure the annoyance and the terror he lived in must have
  • greatly hastened his early and unhappy death.
  • All the time he lived with us the captain made no change whatever in his
  • dress but to buy some stockings from a hawker. One of the cocks of his
  • hat having fallen down, he let it hang from that day forth, though it
  • was a great annoyance when it blew. I remember the appearance of his
  • coat, which he patched himself upstairs in his room, and which, before
  • the end, was nothing but patches. He never wrote or received a letter,
  • and he never spoke with any but the neighbours, and with these, for the
  • most part, only when drunk on rum. The great sea-chest none of us had
  • ever seen open.
  • He was only once crossed, and that was towards the end, when my poor
  • father was far gone in a decline that took him off. Dr. Livesey came
  • late one afternoon to see the patient, took a bit of dinner from my
  • mother, and went into the parlour to smoke a pipe until his horse should
  • come down from the hamlet, for we had no stabling at the old Benbow. I
  • followed him in, and I remember observing the contrast the neat, bright
  • doctor, with his powder as white as snow and his bright, black eyes and
  • pleasant manners, made with the coltish country folk, and above all,
  • with that filthy, heavy, bleared scarecrow of a pirate of ours, sitting,
  • far gone in rum, with his arms on the table. Suddenly he--the captain,
  • that is--began to pipe up his eternal song:
  • “Fifteen men on the dead man's chest--
  • Yo-ho-ho, and a bottle of rum!
  • Drink and the devil had done for the rest--
  • Yo-ho-ho, and a bottle of rum!”
  • At first I had supposed “the dead man's chest” to be that identical big
  • box of his upstairs in the front room, and the thought had been mingled
  • in my nightmares with that of the one-legged seafaring man. But by this
  • time we had all long ceased to pay any particular notice to the song; it
  • was new, that night, to nobody but Dr. Livesey, and on him I observed it
  • did not produce an agreeable effect, for he looked up for a moment quite
  • angrily before he went on with his talk to old Taylor, the gardener, on
  • a new cure for the rheumatics. In the meantime, the captain gradually
  • brightened up at his own music, and at last flapped his hand upon
  • the table before him in a way we all knew to mean silence. The voices
  • stopped at once, all but Dr. Livesey's; he went on as before speaking
  • clear and kind and drawing briskly at his pipe between every word or
  • two. The captain glared at him for a while, flapped his hand again,
  • glared still harder, and at last broke out with a villainous, low oath,
  • “Silence, there, between decks!”
  • “Were you addressing me, sir?” says the doctor; and when the ruffian had
  • told him, with another oath, that this was so, “I have only one thing to
  • say to you, sir,” replies the doctor, “that if you keep on drinking rum,
  • the world will soon be quit of a very dirty scoundrel!”
  • The old fellow's fury was awful. He sprang to his feet, drew and opened
  • a sailor's clasp-knife, and balancing it open on the palm of his hand,
  • threatened to pin the doctor to the wall.
  • The doctor never so much as moved. He spoke to him as before, over his
  • shoulder and in the same tone of voice, rather high, so that all the
  • room might hear, but perfectly calm and steady: “If you do not put that
  • knife this instant in your pocket, I promise, upon my honour, you shall
  • hang at the next assizes.”
  • Then followed a battle of looks between them, but the captain soon
  • knuckled under, put up his weapon, and resumed his seat, grumbling like
  • a beaten dog.
  • “And now, sir,” continued the doctor, “since I now know there's such a
  • fellow in my district, you may count I'll have an eye upon you day and
  • night. I'm not a doctor only; I'm a magistrate; and if I catch a breath
  • of complaint against you, if it's only for a piece of incivility like
  • tonight's, I'll take effectual means to have you hunted down and routed
  • out of this. Let that suffice.”
  • Soon after, Dr. Livesey's horse came to the door and he rode away, but
  • the captain held his peace that evening, and for many evenings to come.
  • 2
  • Black Dog Appears and Disappears
  • IT was not very long after this that there occurred the first of the
  • mysterious events that rid us at last of the captain, though not, as you
  • will see, of his affairs. It was a bitter cold winter, with long, hard
  • frosts and heavy gales; and it was plain from the first that my poor
  • father was little likely to see the spring. He sank daily, and my mother
  • and I had all the inn upon our hands, and were kept busy enough without
  • paying much regard to our unpleasant guest.
  • It was one January morning, very early--a pinching, frosty morning--the
  • cove all grey with hoar-frost, the ripple lapping softly on the stones,
  • the sun still low and only touching the hilltops and shining far to
  • seaward. The captain had risen earlier than usual and set out down the
  • beach, his cutlass swinging under the broad skirts of the old blue coat,
  • his brass telescope under his arm, his hat tilted back upon his head. I
  • remember his breath hanging like smoke in his wake as he strode off, and
  • the last sound I heard of him as he turned the big rock was a loud snort
  • of indignation, as though his mind was still running upon Dr. Livesey.
  • Well, mother was upstairs with father and I was laying the
  • breakfast-table against the captain's return when the parlour door
  • opened and a man stepped in on whom I had never set my eyes before. He
  • was a pale, tallowy creature, wanting two fingers of the left hand, and
  • though he wore a cutlass, he did not look much like a fighter. I
  • had always my eye open for seafaring men, with one leg or two, and I
  • remember this one puzzled me. He was not sailorly, and yet he had a
  • smack of the sea about him too.
  • I asked him what was for his service, and he said he would take rum; but
  • as I was going out of the room to fetch it, he sat down upon a table
  • and motioned me to draw near. I paused where I was, with my napkin in my
  • hand.
  • “Come here, sonny,” says he. “Come nearer here.”
  • I took a step nearer.
  • “Is this here table for my mate Bill?” he asked with a kind of leer.
  • I told him I did not know his mate Bill, and this was for a person who
  • stayed in our house whom we called the captain.
  • “Well,” said he, “my mate Bill would be called the captain, as like
  • as not. He has a cut on one cheek and a mighty pleasant way with him,
  • particularly in drink, has my mate Bill. We'll put it, for argument
  • like, that your captain has a cut on one cheek--and we'll put it, if you
  • like, that that cheek's the right one. Ah, well! I told you. Now, is my
  • mate Bill in this here house?”
  • I told him he was out walking.
  • “Which way, sonny? Which way is he gone?”
  • And when I had pointed out the rock and told him how the captain was
  • likely to return, and how soon, and answered a few other questions,
  • “Ah,” said he, “this'll be as good as drink to my mate Bill.”
  • The expression of his face as he said these words was not at all
  • pleasant, and I had my own reasons for thinking that the stranger was
  • mistaken, even supposing he meant what he said. But it was no affair of
  • mine, I thought; and besides, it was difficult to know what to do. The
  • stranger kept hanging about just inside the inn door, peering round the
  • corner like a cat waiting for a mouse. Once I stepped out myself into
  • the road, but he immediately called me back, and as I did not obey quick
  • enough for his fancy, a most horrible change came over his tallowy face,
  • and he ordered me in with an oath that made me jump. As soon as I
  • was back again he returned to his former manner, half fawning, half
  • sneering, patted me on the shoulder, told me I was a good boy and he had
  • taken quite a fancy to me. “I have a son of my own,” said he, “as like
  • you as two blocks, and he's all the pride of my 'art. But the great
  • thing for boys is discipline, sonny--discipline. Now, if you had sailed
  • along of Bill, you wouldn't have stood there to be spoke to twice--not
  • you. That was never Bill's way, nor the way of sich as sailed with him.
  • And here, sure enough, is my mate Bill, with a spy-glass under his arm,
  • bless his old 'art, to be sure. You and me'll just go back into the
  • parlour, sonny, and get behind the door, and we'll give Bill a little
  • surprise--bless his 'art, I say again.”
  • So saying, the stranger backed along with me into the parlour and put me
  • behind him in the corner so that we were both hidden by the open door. I
  • was very uneasy and alarmed, as you may fancy, and it rather added to my
  • fears to observe that the stranger was certainly frightened himself. He
  • cleared the hilt of his cutlass and loosened the blade in the sheath;
  • and all the time we were waiting there he kept swallowing as if he felt
  • what we used to call a lump in the throat.
  • At last in strode the captain, slammed the door behind him, without
  • looking to the right or left, and marched straight across the room to
  • where his breakfast awaited him.
  • “Bill,” said the stranger in a voice that I thought he had tried to make
  • bold and big.
  • The captain spun round on his heel and fronted us; all the brown had
  • gone out of his face, and even his nose was blue; he had the look of a
  • man who sees a ghost, or the evil one, or something worse, if anything
  • can be; and upon my word, I felt sorry to see him all in a moment turn
  • so old and sick.
  • “Come, Bill, you know me; you know an old shipmate, Bill, surely,” said
  • the stranger.
  • The captain made a sort of gasp.
  • “Black Dog!” said he.
  • “And who else?” returned the other, getting more at his ease. “Black
  • Dog as ever was, come for to see his old shipmate Billy, at the Admiral
  • Benbow inn. Ah, Bill, Bill, we have seen a sight of times, us two, since
  • I lost them two talons,” holding up his mutilated hand.
  • “Now, look here,” said the captain; “you've run me down; here I am;
  • well, then, speak up; what is it?”
  • “That's you, Bill,” returned Black Dog, “you're in the right of it,
  • Billy. I'll have a glass of rum from this dear child here, as I've took
  • such a liking to; and we'll sit down, if you please, and talk square,
  • like old shipmates.”
  • When I returned with the rum, they were already seated on either side
  • of the captain's breakfast-table--Black Dog next to the door and
  • sitting sideways so as to have one eye on his old shipmate and one, as I
  • thought, on his retreat.
  • He bade me go and leave the door wide open. “None of your keyholes for
  • me, sonny,” he said; and I left them together and retired into the bar.
  • For a long time, though I certainly did my best to listen, I could hear
  • nothing but a low gattling; but at last the voices began to grow higher,
  • and I could pick up a word or two, mostly oaths, from the captain.
  • “No, no, no, no; and an end of it!” he cried once. And again, “If it
  • comes to swinging, swing all, say I.”
  • Then all of a sudden there was a tremendous explosion of oaths and
  • other noises--the chair and table went over in a lump, a clash of steel
  • followed, and then a cry of pain, and the next instant I saw Black
  • Dog in full flight, and the captain hotly pursuing, both with drawn
  • cutlasses, and the former streaming blood from the left shoulder. Just
  • at the door the captain aimed at the fugitive one last tremendous
  • cut, which would certainly have split him to the chine had it not been
  • intercepted by our big signboard of Admiral Benbow. You may see the
  • notch on the lower side of the frame to this day.
  • That blow was the last of the battle. Once out upon the road, Black
  • Dog, in spite of his wound, showed a wonderful clean pair of heels and
  • disappeared over the edge of the hill in half a minute. The captain, for
  • his part, stood staring at the signboard like a bewildered man. Then he
  • passed his hand over his eyes several times and at last turned back into
  • the house.
  • “Jim,” says he, “rum”; and as he spoke, he reeled a little, and caught
  • himself with one hand against the wall.
  • “Are you hurt?” cried I.
  • “Rum,” he repeated. “I must get away from here. Rum! Rum!”
  • I ran to fetch it, but I was quite unsteadied by all that had fallen
  • out, and I broke one glass and fouled the tap, and while I was still
  • getting in my own way, I heard a loud fall in the parlour, and running
  • in, beheld the captain lying full length upon the floor. At the same
  • instant my mother, alarmed by the cries and fighting, came running
  • downstairs to help me. Between us we raised his head. He was breathing
  • very loud and hard, but his eyes were closed and his face a horrible
  • colour.
  • “Dear, deary me,” cried my mother, “what a disgrace upon the house! And
  • your poor father sick!”
  • In the meantime, we had no idea what to do to help the captain, nor any
  • other thought but that he had got his death-hurt in the scuffle with
  • the stranger. I got the rum, to be sure, and tried to put it down his
  • throat, but his teeth were tightly shut and his jaws as strong as iron.
  • It was a happy relief for us when the door opened and Doctor Livesey
  • came in, on his visit to my father.
  • “Oh, doctor,” we cried, “what shall we do? Where is he wounded?”
  • “Wounded? A fiddle-stick's end!” said the doctor. “No more wounded than
  • you or I. The man has had a stroke, as I warned him. Now, Mrs. Hawkins,
  • just you run upstairs to your husband and tell him, if possible, nothing
  • about it. For my part, I must do my best to save this fellow's trebly
  • worthless life; Jim, you get me a basin.”
  • When I got back with the basin, the doctor had already ripped up the
  • captain's sleeve and exposed his great sinewy arm. It was tattooed
  • in several places. “Here's luck,” “A fair wind,” and “Billy Bones his
  • fancy,” were very neatly and clearly executed on the forearm; and up
  • near the shoulder there was a sketch of a gallows and a man hanging from
  • it--done, as I thought, with great spirit.
  • “Prophetic,” said the doctor, touching this picture with his finger.
  • “And now, Master Billy Bones, if that be your name, we'll have a look at
  • the colour of your blood. Jim,” he said, “are you afraid of blood?”
  • “No, sir,” said I.
  • “Well, then,” said he, “you hold the basin”; and with that he took his
  • lancet and opened a vein.
  • A great deal of blood was taken before the captain opened his eyes
  • and looked mistily about him. First he recognized the doctor with
  • an unmistakable frown; then his glance fell upon me, and he looked
  • relieved. But suddenly his colour changed, and he tried to raise
  • himself, crying, “Where's Black Dog?”
  • “There is no Black Dog here,” said the doctor, “except what you have
  • on your own back. You have been drinking rum; you have had a stroke,
  • precisely as I told you; and I have just, very much against my own will,
  • dragged you headforemost out of the grave. Now, Mr. Bones--”
  • “That's not my name,” he interrupted.
  • “Much I care,” returned the doctor. “It's the name of a buccaneer of my
  • acquaintance; and I call you by it for the sake of shortness, and what I
  • have to say to you is this; one glass of rum won't kill you, but if
  • you take one you'll take another and another, and I stake my wig if you
  • don't break off short, you'll die--do you understand that?--die, and go
  • to your own place, like the man in the Bible. Come, now, make an effort.
  • I'll help you to your bed for once.”
  • Between us, with much trouble, we managed to hoist him upstairs, and
  • laid him on his bed, where his head fell back on the pillow as if he
  • were almost fainting.
  • “Now, mind you,” said the doctor, “I clear my conscience--the name of
  • rum for you is death.”
  • And with that he went off to see my father, taking me with him by the
  • arm.
  • “This is nothing,” he said as soon as he had closed the door. “I have
  • drawn blood enough to keep him quiet awhile; he should lie for a week
  • where he is--that is the best thing for him and you; but another stroke
  • would settle him.”
  • 3
  • The Black Spot
  • ABOUT noon I stopped at the captain's door with some cooling drinks
  • and medicines. He was lying very much as we had left him, only a little
  • higher, and he seemed both weak and excited.
  • “Jim,” he said, “you're the only one here that's worth anything, and you
  • know I've been always good to you. Never a month but I've given you a
  • silver fourpenny for yourself. And now you see, mate, I'm pretty low,
  • and deserted by all; and Jim, you'll bring me one noggin of rum, now,
  • won't you, matey?”
  • “The doctor--” I began.
  • But he broke in cursing the doctor, in a feeble voice but heartily.
  • “Doctors is all swabs,” he said; “and that doctor there, why, what do
  • he know about seafaring men? I been in places hot as pitch, and mates
  • dropping round with Yellow Jack, and the blessed land a-heaving like the
  • sea with earthquakes--what to the doctor know of lands like that?--and I
  • lived on rum, I tell you. It's been meat and drink, and man and wife,
  • to me; and if I'm not to have my rum now I'm a poor old hulk on a lee
  • shore, my blood'll be on you, Jim, and that doctor swab”; and he ran on
  • again for a while with curses. “Look, Jim, how my fingers fidges,”
  • he continued in the pleading tone. “I can't keep 'em still, not I. I
  • haven't had a drop this blessed day. That doctor's a fool, I tell you.
  • If I don't have a dram o' rum, Jim, I'll have the horrors; I seen some
  • on 'em already. I seen old Flint in the corner there, behind you; as
  • plain as print, I seen him; and if I get the horrors, I'm a man that
  • has lived rough, and I'll raise Cain. Your doctor hisself said one glass
  • wouldn't hurt me. I'll give you a golden guinea for a noggin, Jim.”
  • He was growing more and more excited, and this alarmed me for my father,
  • who was very low that day and needed quiet; besides, I was reassured by
  • the doctor's words, now quoted to me, and rather offended by the offer
  • of a bribe.
  • “I want none of your money,” said I, “but what you owe my father. I'll
  • get you one glass, and no more.”
  • When I brought it to him, he seized it greedily and drank it out.
  • “Aye, aye,” said he, “that's some better, sure enough. And now, matey,
  • did that doctor say how long I was to lie here in this old berth?”
  • “A week at least,” said I.
  • “Thunder!” he cried. “A week! I can't do that; they'd have the black
  • spot on me by then. The lubbers is going about to get the wind of me
  • this blessed moment; lubbers as couldn't keep what they got, and want to
  • nail what is another's. Is that seamanly behaviour, now, I want to know?
  • But I'm a saving soul. I never wasted good money of mine, nor lost it
  • neither; and I'll trick 'em again. I'm not afraid on 'em. I'll shake out
  • another reef, matey, and daddle 'em again.”
  • As he was thus speaking, he had risen from bed with great difficulty,
  • holding to my shoulder with a grip that almost made me cry out, and
  • moving his legs like so much dead weight. His words, spirited as they
  • were in meaning, contrasted sadly with the weakness of the voice in
  • which they were uttered. He paused when he had got into a sitting
  • position on the edge.
  • “That doctor's done me,” he murmured. “My ears is singing. Lay me back.”
  • Before I could do much to help him he had fallen back again to his
  • former place, where he lay for a while silent.
  • “Jim,” he said at length, “you saw that seafaring man today?”
  • “Black Dog?” I asked.
  • “Ah! Black Dog,” says he. “HE'S a bad un; but there's worse that put him
  • on. Now, if I can't get away nohow, and they tip me the black spot, mind
  • you, it's my old sea-chest they're after; you get on a horse--you can,
  • can't you? Well, then, you get on a horse, and go to--well, yes,
  • I will!--to that eternal doctor swab, and tell him to pipe all
  • hands--magistrates and sich--and he'll lay 'em aboard at the Admiral
  • Benbow--all old Flint's crew, man and boy, all on 'em that's left. I was
  • first mate, I was, old Flint's first mate, and I'm the on'y one as knows
  • the place. He gave it me at Savannah, when he lay a-dying, like as if I
  • was to now, you see. But you won't peach unless they get the black spot
  • on me, or unless you see that Black Dog again or a seafaring man with
  • one leg, Jim--him above all.”
  • “But what is the black spot, captain?” I asked.
  • “That's a summons, mate. I'll tell you if they get that. But you keep
  • your weather-eye open, Jim, and I'll share with you equals, upon my
  • honour.”
  • He wandered a little longer, his voice growing weaker; but soon after I
  • had given him his medicine, which he took like a child, with the remark,
  • “If ever a seaman wanted drugs, it's me,” he fell at last into a heavy,
  • swoon-like sleep, in which I left him. What I should have done had all
  • gone well I do not know. Probably I should have told the whole story to
  • the doctor, for I was in mortal fear lest the captain should repent of
  • his confessions and make an end of me. But as things fell out, my poor
  • father died quite suddenly that evening, which put all other matters
  • on one side. Our natural distress, the visits of the neighbours, the
  • arranging of the funeral, and all the work of the inn to be carried on
  • in the meanwhile kept me so busy that I had scarcely time to think of
  • the captain, far less to be afraid of him.
  • He got downstairs next morning, to be sure, and had his meals as usual,
  • though he ate little and had more, I am afraid, than his usual supply of
  • rum, for he helped himself out of the bar, scowling and blowing through
  • his nose, and no one dared to cross him. On the night before the funeral
  • he was as drunk as ever; and it was shocking, in that house of mourning,
  • to hear him singing away at his ugly old sea-song; but weak as he was,
  • we were all in the fear of death for him, and the doctor was suddenly
  • taken up with a case many miles away and was never near the house after
  • my father's death. I have said the captain was weak, and indeed he
  • seemed rather to grow weaker than regain his strength. He clambered up
  • and down stairs, and went from the parlour to the bar and back again,
  • and sometimes put his nose out of doors to smell the sea, holding on to
  • the walls as he went for support and breathing hard and fast like a man
  • on a steep mountain. He never particularly addressed me, and it is my
  • belief he had as good as forgotten his confidences; but his temper was
  • more flighty, and allowing for his bodily weakness, more violent than
  • ever. He had an alarming way now when he was drunk of drawing his
  • cutlass and laying it bare before him on the table. But with all that,
  • he minded people less and seemed shut up in his own thoughts and rather
  • wandering. Once, for instance, to our extreme wonder, he piped up to a
  • different air, a kind of country love-song that he must have learned in
  • his youth before he had begun to follow the sea.
  • So things passed until, the day after the funeral, and about three
  • o'clock of a bitter, foggy, frosty afternoon, I was standing at the door
  • for a moment, full of sad thoughts about my father, when I saw someone
  • drawing slowly near along the road. He was plainly blind, for he tapped
  • before him with a stick and wore a great green shade over his eyes and
  • nose; and he was hunched, as if with age or weakness, and wore a huge
  • old tattered sea-cloak with a hood that made him appear positively
  • deformed. I never saw in my life a more dreadful-looking figure.
  • He stopped a little from the inn, and raising his voice in an odd
  • sing-song, addressed the air in front of him, “Will any kind friend
  • inform a poor blind man, who has lost the precious sight of his eyes in
  • the gracious defence of his native country, England--and God bless King
  • George!--where or in what part of this country he may now be?”
  • “You are at the Admiral Benbow, Black Hill Cove, my good man,” said I.
  • “I hear a voice,” said he, “a young voice. Will you give me your hand,
  • my kind young friend, and lead me in?”
  • I held out my hand, and the horrible, soft-spoken, eyeless creature
  • gripped it in a moment like a vise. I was so much startled that I
  • struggled to withdraw, but the blind man pulled me close up to him with
  • a single action of his arm.
  • “Now, boy,” he said, “take me in to the captain.”
  • “Sir,” said I, “upon my word I dare not.”
  • “Oh,” he sneered, “that's it! Take me in straight or I'll break your
  • arm.”
  • And he gave it, as he spoke, a wrench that made me cry out.
  • “Sir,” said I, “it is for yourself I mean. The captain is not what he
  • used to be. He sits with a drawn cutlass. Another gentleman--”
  • “Come, now, march,” interrupted he; and I never heard a voice so cruel,
  • and cold, and ugly as that blind man's. It cowed me more than the pain,
  • and I began to obey him at once, walking straight in at the door and
  • towards the parlour, where our sick old buccaneer was sitting, dazed
  • with rum. The blind man clung close to me, holding me in one iron fist
  • and leaning almost more of his weight on me than I could carry. “Lead me
  • straight up to him, and when I'm in view, cry out, 'Here's a friend
  • for you, Bill.' If you don't, I'll do this,” and with that he gave me a
  • twitch that I thought would have made me faint. Between this and that, I
  • was so utterly terrified of the blind beggar that I forgot my terror of
  • the captain, and as I opened the parlour door, cried out the words he
  • had ordered in a trembling voice.
  • The poor captain raised his eyes, and at one look the rum went out of
  • him and left him staring sober. The expression of his face was not so
  • much of terror as of mortal sickness. He made a movement to rise, but I
  • do not believe he had enough force left in his body.
  • “Now, Bill, sit where you are,” said the beggar. “If I can't see, I can
  • hear a finger stirring. Business is business. Hold out your left hand.
  • Boy, take his left hand by the wrist and bring it near to my right.”
  • We both obeyed him to the letter, and I saw him pass something from the
  • hollow of the hand that held his stick into the palm of the captain's,
  • which closed upon it instantly.
  • “And now that's done,” said the blind man; and at the words he suddenly
  • left hold of me, and with incredible accuracy and nimbleness,
  • skipped out of the parlour and into the road, where, as I still stood
  • motionless, I could hear his stick go tap-tap-tapping into the distance.
  • It was some time before either I or the captain seemed to gather our
  • senses, but at length, and about at the same moment, I released his
  • wrist, which I was still holding, and he drew in his hand and looked
  • sharply into the palm.
  • “Ten o'clock!” he cried. “Six hours. We'll do them yet,” and he sprang
  • to his feet.
  • Even as he did so, he reeled, put his hand to his throat, stood swaying
  • for a moment, and then, with a peculiar sound, fell from his whole
  • height face foremost to the floor.
  • I ran to him at once, calling to my mother. But haste was all in vain.
  • The captain had been struck dead by thundering apoplexy. It is a curious
  • thing to understand, for I had certainly never liked the man, though of
  • late I had begun to pity him, but as soon as I saw that he was dead, I
  • burst into a flood of tears. It was the second death I had known, and
  • the sorrow of the first was still fresh in my heart.
  • 4
  • The Sea-chest
  • I LOST no time, of course, in telling my mother all that I knew, and
  • perhaps should have told her long before, and we saw ourselves at once
  • in a difficult and dangerous position. Some of the man's money--if
  • he had any--was certainly due to us, but it was not likely that our
  • captain's shipmates, above all the two specimens seen by me, Black
  • Dog and the blind beggar, would be inclined to give up their booty in
  • payment of the dead man's debts. The captain's order to mount at
  • once and ride for Doctor Livesey would have left my mother alone
  • and unprotected, which was not to be thought of. Indeed, it seemed
  • impossible for either of us to remain much longer in the house; the fall
  • of coals in the kitchen grate, the very ticking of the clock, filled
  • us with alarms. The neighbourhood, to our ears, seemed haunted by
  • approaching footsteps; and what between the dead body of the captain
  • on the parlour floor and the thought of that detestable blind beggar
  • hovering near at hand and ready to return, there were moments when, as
  • the saying goes, I jumped in my skin for terror. Something must speedily
  • be resolved upon, and it occurred to us at last to go forth together
  • and seek help in the neighbouring hamlet. No sooner said than done.
  • Bare-headed as we were, we ran out at once in the gathering evening and
  • the frosty fog.
  • The hamlet lay not many hundred yards away, though out of view, on the
  • other side of the next cove; and what greatly encouraged me, it was
  • in an opposite direction from that whence the blind man had made his
  • appearance and whither he had presumably returned. We were not many
  • minutes on the road, though we sometimes stopped to lay hold of each
  • other and hearken. But there was no unusual sound--nothing but the low
  • wash of the ripple and the croaking of the inmates of the wood.
  • It was already candle-light when we reached the hamlet, and I shall
  • never forget how much I was cheered to see the yellow shine in doors and
  • windows; but that, as it proved, was the best of the help we were likely
  • to get in that quarter. For--you would have thought men would have been
  • ashamed of themselves--no soul would consent to return with us to the
  • Admiral Benbow. The more we told of our troubles, the more--man, woman,
  • and child--they clung to the shelter of their houses. The name of
  • Captain Flint, though it was strange to me, was well enough known to
  • some there and carried a great weight of terror. Some of the men who
  • had been to field-work on the far side of the Admiral Benbow remembered,
  • besides, to have seen several strangers on the road, and taking them to
  • be smugglers, to have bolted away; and one at least had seen a little
  • lugger in what we called Kitt's Hole. For that matter, anyone who was a
  • comrade of the captain's was enough to frighten them to death. And the
  • short and the long of the matter was, that while we could get several
  • who were willing enough to ride to Dr. Livesey's, which lay in another
  • direction, not one would help us to defend the inn.
  • They say cowardice is infectious; but then argument is, on the other
  • hand, a great emboldener; and so when each had said his say, my mother
  • made them a speech. She would not, she declared, lose money that
  • belonged to her fatherless boy; “If none of the rest of you dare,”
  • she said, “Jim and I dare. Back we will go, the way we came, and small
  • thanks to you big, hulking, chicken-hearted men. We'll have that chest
  • open, if we die for it. And I'll thank you for that bag, Mrs. Crossley,
  • to bring back our lawful money in.”
  • Of course I said I would go with my mother, and of course they all cried
  • out at our foolhardiness, but even then not a man would go along with
  • us. All they would do was to give me a loaded pistol lest we were
  • attacked, and to promise to have horses ready saddled in case we were
  • pursued on our return, while one lad was to ride forward to the doctor's
  • in search of armed assistance.
  • My heart was beating finely when we two set forth in the cold night upon
  • this dangerous venture. A full moon was beginning to rise and peered
  • redly through the upper edges of the fog, and this increased our haste,
  • for it was plain, before we came forth again, that all would be as
  • bright as day, and our departure exposed to the eyes of any watchers.
  • We slipped along the hedges, noiseless and swift, nor did we see or hear
  • anything to increase our terrors, till, to our relief, the door of the
  • Admiral Benbow had closed behind us.
  • I slipped the bolt at once, and we stood and panted for a moment in the
  • dark, alone in the house with the dead captain's body. Then my mother
  • got a candle in the bar, and holding each other's hands, we advanced
  • into the parlour. He lay as we had left him, on his back, with his eyes
  • open and one arm stretched out.
  • “Draw down the blind, Jim,” whispered my mother; “they might come and
  • watch outside. And now,” said she when I had done so, “we have to get
  • the key off THAT; and who's to touch it, I should like to know!” and she
  • gave a kind of sob as she said the words.
  • I went down on my knees at once. On the floor close to his hand there
  • was a little round of paper, blackened on the one side. I could not
  • doubt that this was the BLACK SPOT; and taking it up, I found written
  • on the other side, in a very good, clear hand, this short message: “You
  • have till ten tonight.”
  • “He had till ten, Mother,” said I; and just as I said it, our old clock
  • began striking. This sudden noise startled us shockingly; but the news
  • was good, for it was only six.
  • “Now, Jim,” she said, “that key.”
  • I felt in his pockets, one after another. A few small coins, a thimble,
  • and some thread and big needles, a piece of pigtail tobacco bitten away
  • at the end, his gully with the crooked handle, a pocket compass, and a
  • tinder box were all that they contained, and I began to despair.
  • “Perhaps it's round his neck,” suggested my mother.
  • Overcoming a strong repugnance, I tore open his shirt at the neck, and
  • there, sure enough, hanging to a bit of tarry string, which I cut with
  • his own gully, we found the key. At this triumph we were filled with
  • hope and hurried upstairs without delay to the little room where he had
  • slept so long and where his box had stood since the day of his arrival.
  • It was like any other seaman's chest on the outside, the initial “B”
  • burned on the top of it with a hot iron, and the corners somewhat
  • smashed and broken as by long, rough usage.
  • “Give me the key,” said my mother; and though the lock was very stiff,
  • she had turned it and thrown back the lid in a twinkling.
  • A strong smell of tobacco and tar rose from the interior, but nothing
  • was to be seen on the top except a suit of very good clothes, carefully
  • brushed and folded. They had never been worn, my mother said. Under
  • that, the miscellany began--a quadrant, a tin canikin, several sticks of
  • tobacco, two brace of very handsome pistols, a piece of bar silver, an
  • old Spanish watch and some other trinkets of little value and mostly of
  • foreign make, a pair of compasses mounted with brass, and five or six
  • curious West Indian shells. I have often wondered since why he should
  • have carried about these shells with him in his wandering, guilty, and
  • hunted life.
  • In the meantime, we had found nothing of any value but the silver and
  • the trinkets, and neither of these were in our way. Underneath there
  • was an old boat-cloak, whitened with sea-salt on many a harbour-bar. My
  • mother pulled it up with impatience, and there lay before us, the last
  • things in the chest, a bundle tied up in oilcloth, and looking like
  • papers, and a canvas bag that gave forth, at a touch, the jingle of
  • gold.
  • “I'll show these rogues that I'm an honest woman,” said my mother. “I'll
  • have my dues, and not a farthing over. Hold Mrs. Crossley's bag.” And
  • she began to count over the amount of the captain's score from the
  • sailor's bag into the one that I was holding.
  • It was a long, difficult business, for the coins were of all countries
  • and sizes--doubloons, and louis d'ors, and guineas, and pieces of eight,
  • and I know not what besides, all shaken together at random. The guineas,
  • too, were about the scarcest, and it was with these only that my mother
  • knew how to make her count.
  • When we were about half-way through, I suddenly put my hand upon her
  • arm, for I had heard in the silent frosty air a sound that brought my
  • heart into my mouth--the tap-tapping of the blind man's stick upon the
  • frozen road. It drew nearer and nearer, while we sat holding our breath.
  • Then it struck sharp on the inn door, and then we could hear the handle
  • being turned and the bolt rattling as the wretched being tried to enter;
  • and then there was a long time of silence both within and without.
  • At last the tapping recommenced, and, to our indescribable joy and
  • gratitude, died slowly away again until it ceased to be heard.
  • “Mother,” said I, “take the whole and let's be going,” for I was sure
  • the bolted door must have seemed suspicious and would bring the whole
  • hornet's nest about our ears, though how thankful I was that I had
  • bolted it, none could tell who had never met that terrible blind man.
  • But my mother, frightened as she was, would not consent to take a
  • fraction more than was due to her and was obstinately unwilling to be
  • content with less. It was not yet seven, she said, by a long way; she
  • knew her rights and she would have them; and she was still arguing with
  • me when a little low whistle sounded a good way off upon the hill. That
  • was enough, and more than enough, for both of us.
  • “I'll take what I have,” she said, jumping to her feet.
  • “And I'll take this to square the count,” said I, picking up the oilskin
  • packet.
  • Next moment we were both groping downstairs, leaving the candle by
  • the empty chest; and the next we had opened the door and were in full
  • retreat. We had not started a moment too soon. The fog was rapidly
  • dispersing; already the moon shone quite clear on the high ground on
  • either side; and it was only in the exact bottom of the dell and round
  • the tavern door that a thin veil still hung unbroken to conceal the
  • first steps of our escape. Far less than half-way to the hamlet, very
  • little beyond the bottom of the hill, we must come forth into the
  • moonlight. Nor was this all, for the sound of several footsteps running
  • came already to our ears, and as we looked back in their direction, a
  • light tossing to and fro and still rapidly advancing showed that one of
  • the newcomers carried a lantern.
  • “My dear,” said my mother suddenly, “take the money and run on. I am
  • going to faint.”
  • This was certainly the end for both of us, I thought. How I cursed the
  • cowardice of the neighbours; how I blamed my poor mother for her honesty
  • and her greed, for her past foolhardiness and present weakness! We were
  • just at the little bridge, by good fortune; and I helped her, tottering
  • as she was, to the edge of the bank, where, sure enough, she gave a sigh
  • and fell on my shoulder. I do not know how I found the strength to do it
  • at all, and I am afraid it was roughly done, but I managed to drag her
  • down the bank and a little way under the arch. Farther I could not move
  • her, for the bridge was too low to let me do more than crawl below it.
  • So there we had to stay--my mother almost entirely exposed and both of
  • us within earshot of the inn.
  • 5
  • The Last of the Blind Man
  • MY curiosity, in a sense, was stronger than my fear, for I could not
  • remain where I was, but crept back to the bank again, whence, sheltering
  • my head behind a bush of broom, I might command the road before our
  • door. I was scarcely in position ere my enemies began to arrive, seven
  • or eight of them, running hard, their feet beating out of time along
  • the road and the man with the lantern some paces in front. Three men ran
  • together, hand in hand; and I made out, even through the mist, that the
  • middle man of this trio was the blind beggar. The next moment his voice
  • showed me that I was right.
  • “Down with the door!” he cried.
  • “Aye, aye, sir!” answered two or three; and a rush was made upon the
  • Admiral Benbow, the lantern-bearer following; and then I could see
  • them pause, and hear speeches passed in a lower key, as if they were
  • surprised to find the door open. But the pause was brief, for the blind
  • man again issued his commands. His voice sounded louder and higher, as
  • if he were afire with eagerness and rage.
  • “In, in, in!” he shouted, and cursed them for their delay.
  • Four or five of them obeyed at once, two remaining on the road with the
  • formidable beggar. There was a pause, then a cry of surprise, and then a
  • voice shouting from the house, “Bill's dead.”
  • But the blind man swore at them again for their delay.
  • “Search him, some of you shirking lubbers, and the rest of you aloft and
  • get the chest,” he cried.
  • I could hear their feet rattling up our old stairs, so that the
  • house must have shook with it. Promptly afterwards, fresh sounds of
  • astonishment arose; the window of the captain's room was thrown open
  • with a slam and a jingle of broken glass, and a man leaned out into the
  • moonlight, head and shoulders, and addressed the blind beggar on the
  • road below him.
  • “Pew,” he cried, “they've been before us. Someone's turned the chest out
  • alow and aloft.”
  • “Is it there?” roared Pew.
  • “The money's there.”
  • The blind man cursed the money.
  • “Flint's fist, I mean,” he cried.
  • “We don't see it here nohow,” returned the man.
  • “Here, you below there, is it on Bill?” cried the blind man again.
  • At that another fellow, probably him who had remained below to search
  • the captain's body, came to the door of the inn. “Bill's been overhauled
  • a'ready,” said he; “nothin' left.”
  • “It's these people of the inn--it's that boy. I wish I had put his eyes
  • out!” cried the blind man, Pew. “There were no time ago--they had the
  • door bolted when I tried it. Scatter, lads, and find 'em.”
  • “Sure enough, they left their glim here,” said the fellow from the
  • window.
  • “Scatter and find 'em! Rout the house out!” reiterated Pew, striking
  • with his stick upon the road.
  • Then there followed a great to-do through all our old inn, heavy feet
  • pounding to and fro, furniture thrown over, doors kicked in, until the
  • very rocks re-echoed and the men came out again, one after another, on
  • the road and declared that we were nowhere to be found. And just
  • the same whistle that had alarmed my mother and myself over the dead
  • captain's money was once more clearly audible through the night,
  • but this time twice repeated. I had thought it to be the blind man's
  • trumpet, so to speak, summoning his crew to the assault, but I now found
  • that it was a signal from the hillside towards the hamlet, and from its
  • effect upon the buccaneers, a signal to warn them of approaching danger.
  • “There's Dirk again,” said one. “Twice! We'll have to budge, mates.”
  • “Budge, you skulk!” cried Pew. “Dirk was a fool and a coward from the
  • first--you wouldn't mind him. They must be close by; they can't be far;
  • you have your hands on it. Scatter and look for them, dogs! Oh, shiver
  • my soul,” he cried, “if I had eyes!”
  • This appeal seemed to produce some effect, for two of the fellows began
  • to look here and there among the lumber, but half-heartedly, I thought,
  • and with half an eye to their own danger all the time, while the rest
  • stood irresolute on the road.
  • “You have your hands on thousands, you fools, and you hang a leg! You'd
  • be as rich as kings if you could find it, and you know it's here, and
  • you stand there skulking. There wasn't one of you dared face Bill, and
  • I did it--a blind man! And I'm to lose my chance for you! I'm to be a
  • poor, crawling beggar, sponging for rum, when I might be rolling in a
  • coach! If you had the pluck of a weevil in a biscuit you would catch
  • them still.”
  • “Hang it, Pew, we've got the doubloons!” grumbled one.
  • “They might have hid the blessed thing,” said another. “Take the
  • Georges, Pew, and don't stand here squalling.”
  • Squalling was the word for it; Pew's anger rose so high at these
  • objections till at last, his passion completely taking the upper hand,
  • he struck at them right and left in his blindness and his stick sounded
  • heavily on more than one.
  • These, in their turn, cursed back at the blind miscreant, threatened him
  • in horrid terms, and tried in vain to catch the stick and wrest it from
  • his grasp.
  • This quarrel was the saving of us, for while it was still raging,
  • another sound came from the top of the hill on the side of the
  • hamlet--the tramp of horses galloping. Almost at the same time a
  • pistol-shot, flash and report, came from the hedge side. And that was
  • plainly the last signal of danger, for the buccaneers turned at once
  • and ran, separating in every direction, one seaward along the cove, one
  • slant across the hill, and so on, so that in half a minute not a sign of
  • them remained but Pew. Him they had deserted, whether in sheer panic
  • or out of revenge for his ill words and blows I know not; but there he
  • remained behind, tapping up and down the road in a frenzy, and groping
  • and calling for his comrades. Finally he took a wrong turn and ran a few
  • steps past me, towards the hamlet, crying, “Johnny, Black Dog, Dirk,”
  • and other names, “you won't leave old Pew, mates--not old Pew!”
  • Just then the noise of horses topped the rise, and four or five riders
  • came in sight in the moonlight and swept at full gallop down the slope.
  • At this Pew saw his error, turned with a scream, and ran straight for
  • the ditch, into which he rolled. But he was on his feet again in a
  • second and made another dash, now utterly bewildered, right under the
  • nearest of the coming horses.
  • The rider tried to save him, but in vain. Down went Pew with a cry that
  • rang high into the night; and the four hoofs trampled and spurned him
  • and passed by. He fell on his side, then gently collapsed upon his face
  • and moved no more.
  • I leaped to my feet and hailed the riders. They were pulling up, at any
  • rate, horrified at the accident; and I soon saw what they were. One,
  • tailing out behind the rest, was a lad that had gone from the hamlet to
  • Dr. Livesey's; the rest were revenue officers, whom he had met by the
  • way, and with whom he had had the intelligence to return at once. Some
  • news of the lugger in Kitt's Hole had found its way to Supervisor Dance
  • and set him forth that night in our direction, and to that circumstance
  • my mother and I owed our preservation from death.
  • Pew was dead, stone dead. As for my mother, when we had carried her up
  • to the hamlet, a little cold water and salts and that soon brought her
  • back again, and she was none the worse for her terror, though she still
  • continued to deplore the balance of the money. In the meantime the
  • supervisor rode on, as fast as he could, to Kitt's Hole; but his men
  • had to dismount and grope down the dingle, leading, and sometimes
  • supporting, their horses, and in continual fear of ambushes; so it was
  • no great matter for surprise that when they got down to the Hole the
  • lugger was already under way, though still close in. He hailed her. A
  • voice replied, telling him to keep out of the moonlight or he would get
  • some lead in him, and at the same time a bullet whistled close by his
  • arm. Soon after, the lugger doubled the point and disappeared. Mr. Dance
  • stood there, as he said, “like a fish out of water,” and all he could do
  • was to dispatch a man to B---- to warn the cutter. “And that,” said he,
  • “is just about as good as nothing. They've got off clean, and there's
  • an end. Only,” he added, “I'm glad I trod on Master Pew's corns,” for by
  • this time he had heard my story.
  • I went back with him to the Admiral Benbow, and you cannot imagine a
  • house in such a state of smash; the very clock had been thrown down
  • by these fellows in their furious hunt after my mother and myself;
  • and though nothing had actually been taken away except the captain's
  • money-bag and a little silver from the till, I could see at once that we
  • were ruined. Mr. Dance could make nothing of the scene.
  • “They got the money, you say? Well, then, Hawkins, what in fortune were
  • they after? More money, I suppose?”
  • “No, sir; not money, I think,” replied I. “In fact, sir, I believe I
  • have the thing in my breast pocket; and to tell you the truth, I should
  • like to get it put in safety.”
  • “To be sure, boy; quite right,” said he. “I'll take it, if you like.”
  • “I thought perhaps Dr. Livesey--” I began.
  • “Perfectly right,” he interrupted very cheerily, “perfectly right--a
  • gentleman and a magistrate. And, now I come to think of it, I might as
  • well ride round there myself and report to him or squire. Master Pew's
  • dead, when all's done; not that I regret it, but he's dead, you see, and
  • people will make it out against an officer of his Majesty's revenue,
  • if make it out they can. Now, I'll tell you, Hawkins, if you like, I'll
  • take you along.”
  • I thanked him heartily for the offer, and we walked back to the hamlet
  • where the horses were. By the time I had told mother of my purpose they
  • were all in the saddle.
  • “Dogger,” said Mr. Dance, “you have a good horse; take up this lad
  • behind you.”
  • As soon as I was mounted, holding on to Dogger's belt, the supervisor
  • gave the word, and the party struck out at a bouncing trot on the road
  • to Dr. Livesey's house.
  • 6
  • The Captain's Papers
  • WE rode hard all the way till we drew up before Dr. Livesey's door. The
  • house was all dark to the front.
  • Mr. Dance told me to jump down and knock, and Dogger gave me a stirrup
  • to descend by. The door was opened almost at once by the maid.
  • “Is Dr. Livesey in?” I asked.
  • No, she said, he had come home in the afternoon but had gone up to the
  • hall to dine and pass the evening with the squire.
  • “So there we go, boys,” said Mr. Dance.
  • This time, as the distance was short, I did not mount, but ran with
  • Dogger's stirrup-leather to the lodge gates and up the long, leafless,
  • moonlit avenue to where the white line of the hall buildings looked on
  • either hand on great old gardens. Here Mr. Dance dismounted, and taking
  • me along with him, was admitted at a word into the house.
  • The servant led us down a matted passage and showed us at the end into a
  • great library, all lined with bookcases and busts upon the top of them,
  • where the squire and Dr. Livesey sat, pipe in hand, on either side of a
  • bright fire.
  • I had never seen the squire so near at hand. He was a tall man, over six
  • feet high, and broad in proportion, and he had a bluff, rough-and-ready
  • face, all roughened and reddened and lined in his long travels. His
  • eyebrows were very black, and moved readily, and this gave him a look of
  • some temper, not bad, you would say, but quick and high.
  • “Come in, Mr. Dance,” says he, very stately and condescending.
  • “Good evening, Dance,” says the doctor with a nod. “And good evening to
  • you, friend Jim. What good wind brings you here?”
  • The supervisor stood up straight and stiff and told his story like a
  • lesson; and you should have seen how the two gentlemen leaned forward
  • and looked at each other, and forgot to smoke in their surprise and
  • interest. When they heard how my mother went back to the inn, Dr.
  • Livesey fairly slapped his thigh, and the squire cried “Bravo!” and
  • broke his long pipe against the grate. Long before it was done, Mr.
  • Trelawney (that, you will remember, was the squire's name) had got up
  • from his seat and was striding about the room, and the doctor, as if to
  • hear the better, had taken off his powdered wig and sat there looking
  • very strange indeed with his own close-cropped black poll.
  • At last Mr. Dance finished the story.
  • “Mr. Dance,” said the squire, “you are a very noble fellow. And as for
  • riding down that black, atrocious miscreant, I regard it as an act of
  • virtue, sir, like stamping on a cockroach. This lad Hawkins is a trump,
  • I perceive. Hawkins, will you ring that bell? Mr. Dance must have some
  • ale.”
  • “And so, Jim,” said the doctor, “you have the thing that they were
  • after, have you?”
  • “Here it is, sir,” said I, and gave him the oilskin packet.
  • The doctor looked it all over, as if his fingers were itching to open
  • it; but instead of doing that, he put it quietly in the pocket of his
  • coat.
  • “Squire,” said he, “when Dance has had his ale he must, of course, be
  • off on his Majesty's service; but I mean to keep Jim Hawkins here to
  • sleep at my house, and with your permission, I propose we should have up
  • the cold pie and let him sup.”
  • “As you will, Livesey,” said the squire; “Hawkins has earned better than
  • cold pie.”
  • So a big pigeon pie was brought in and put on a sidetable, and I made
  • a hearty supper, for I was as hungry as a hawk, while Mr. Dance was
  • further complimented and at last dismissed.
  • “And now, squire,” said the doctor.
  • “And now, Livesey,” said the squire in the same breath.
  • “One at a time, one at a time,” laughed Dr. Livesey. “You have heard of
  • this Flint, I suppose?”
  • “Heard of him!” cried the squire. “Heard of him, you say! He was the
  • bloodthirstiest buccaneer that sailed. Blackbeard was a child to Flint.
  • The Spaniards were so prodigiously afraid of him that, I tell you, sir,
  • I was sometimes proud he was an Englishman. I've seen his top-sails with
  • these eyes, off Trinidad, and the cowardly son of a rum-puncheon that I
  • sailed with put back--put back, sir, into Port of Spain.”
  • “Well, I've heard of him myself, in England,” said the doctor. “But the
  • point is, had he money?”
  • “Money!” cried the squire. “Have you heard the story? What were these
  • villains after but money? What do they care for but money? For what
  • would they risk their rascal carcasses but money?”
  • “That we shall soon know,” replied the doctor. “But you are so
  • confoundedly hot-headed and exclamatory that I cannot get a word in.
  • What I want to know is this: Supposing that I have here in my pocket
  • some clue to where Flint buried his treasure, will that treasure amount
  • to much?”
  • “Amount, sir!” cried the squire. “It will amount to this: If we have the
  • clue you talk about, I fit out a ship in Bristol dock, and take you and
  • Hawkins here along, and I'll have that treasure if I search a year.”
  • “Very well,” said the doctor. “Now, then, if Jim is agreeable, we'll
  • open the packet”; and he laid it before him on the table.
  • The bundle was sewn together, and the doctor had to get out his
  • instrument case and cut the stitches with his medical scissors. It
  • contained two things--a book and a sealed paper.
  • “First of all we'll try the book,” observed the doctor.
  • The squire and I were both peering over his shoulder as he opened
  • it, for Dr. Livesey had kindly motioned me to come round from the
  • side-table, where I had been eating, to enjoy the sport of the search.
  • On the first page there were only some scraps of writing, such as a man
  • with a pen in his hand might make for idleness or practice. One was the
  • same as the tattoo mark, “Billy Bones his fancy”; then there was “Mr. W.
  • Bones, mate,” “No more rum,” “Off Palm Key he got itt,” and some other
  • snatches, mostly single words and unintelligible. I could not help
  • wondering who it was that had “got itt,” and what “itt” was that he got.
  • A knife in his back as like as not.
  • “Not much instruction there,” said Dr. Livesey as he passed on.
  • The next ten or twelve pages were filled with a curious series of
  • entries. There was a date at one end of the line and at the other a
  • sum of money, as in common account-books, but instead of explanatory
  • writing, only a varying number of crosses between the two. On the 12th
  • of June, 1745, for instance, a sum of seventy pounds had plainly become
  • due to someone, and there was nothing but six crosses to explain the
  • cause. In a few cases, to be sure, the name of a place would be added,
  • as “Offe Caraccas,” or a mere entry of latitude and longitude, as “62o
  • 17' 20”, 19o 2' 40”.”
  • The record lasted over nearly twenty years, the amount of the separate
  • entries growing larger as time went on, and at the end a grand total
  • had been made out after five or six wrong additions, and these words
  • appended, “Bones, his pile.”
  • “I can't make head or tail of this,” said Dr. Livesey.
  • “The thing is as clear as noonday,” cried the squire. “This is the
  • black-hearted hound's account-book. These crosses stand for the names of
  • ships or towns that they sank or plundered. The sums are the scoundrel's
  • share, and where he feared an ambiguity, you see he added something
  • clearer. 'Offe Caraccas,' now; you see, here was some unhappy vessel
  • boarded off that coast. God help the poor souls that manned her--coral
  • long ago.”
  • “Right!” said the doctor. “See what it is to be a traveller. Right! And
  • the amounts increase, you see, as he rose in rank.”
  • There was little else in the volume but a few bearings of places noted
  • in the blank leaves towards the end and a table for reducing French,
  • English, and Spanish moneys to a common value.
  • “Thrifty man!” cried the doctor. “He wasn't the one to be cheated.”
  • “And now,” said the squire, “for the other.”
  • The paper had been sealed in several places with a thimble by way of
  • seal; the very thimble, perhaps, that I had found in the captain's
  • pocket. The doctor opened the seals with great care, and there fell out
  • the map of an island, with latitude and longitude, soundings, names of
  • hills and bays and inlets, and every particular that would be needed
  • to bring a ship to a safe anchorage upon its shores. It was about nine
  • miles long and five across, shaped, you might say, like a fat dragon
  • standing up, and had two fine land-locked harbours, and a hill in the
  • centre part marked “The Spy-glass.” There were several additions of a
  • later date, but above all, three crosses of red ink--two on the north
  • part of the island, one in the southwest--and beside this last, in
  • the same red ink, and in a small, neat hand, very different from the
  • captain's tottery characters, these words: “Bulk of treasure here.”
  • Over on the back the same hand had written this further information:
  • Tall tree, Spy-glass shoulder, bearing a point to
  • the N. of N.N.E.
  • Skeleton Island E.S.E. and by E.
  • Ten feet.
  • The bar silver is in the north cache; you can find
  • it by the trend of the east hummock, ten fathoms
  • south of the black crag with the face on it.
  • The arms are easy found, in the sand-hill, N.
  • point of north inlet cape, bearing E. and a
  • quarter N.
  • J.F.
  • That was all; but brief as it was, and to me incomprehensible, it filled
  • the squire and Dr. Livesey with delight.
  • “Livesey,” said the squire, “you will give up this wretched practice
  • at once. Tomorrow I start for Bristol. In three weeks' time--three
  • weeks!--two weeks--ten days--we'll have the best ship, sir, and the
  • choicest crew in England. Hawkins shall come as cabin-boy. You'll make
  • a famous cabin-boy, Hawkins. You, Livesey, are ship's doctor; I am
  • admiral. We'll take Redruth, Joyce, and Hunter. We'll have favourable
  • winds, a quick passage, and not the least difficulty in finding the
  • spot, and money to eat, to roll in, to play duck and drake with ever
  • after.”
  • “Trelawney,” said the doctor, “I'll go with you; and I'll go bail for
  • it, so will Jim, and be a credit to the undertaking. There's only one
  • man I'm afraid of.”
  • “And who's that?” cried the squire. “Name the dog, sir!”
  • “You,” replied the doctor; “for you cannot hold your tongue. We are not
  • the only men who know of this paper. These fellows who attacked the
  • inn tonight--bold, desperate blades, for sure--and the rest who stayed
  • aboard that lugger, and more, I dare say, not far off, are, one and all,
  • through thick and thin, bound that they'll get that money. We must none
  • of us go alone till we get to sea. Jim and I shall stick together in the
  • meanwhile; you'll take Joyce and Hunter when you ride to Bristol, and
  • from first to last, not one of us must breathe a word of what we've
  • found.”
  • “Livesey,” returned the squire, “you are always in the right of it. I'll
  • be as silent as the grave.”
  • PART TWO--The Sea-cook
  • 7
  • I Go to Bristol
  • IT was longer than the squire imagined ere we were ready for the sea,
  • and none of our first plans--not even Dr. Livesey's, of keeping me
  • beside him--could be carried out as we intended. The doctor had to go
  • to London for a physician to take charge of his practice; the squire was
  • hard at work at Bristol; and I lived on at the hall under the charge of
  • old Redruth, the gamekeeper, almost a prisoner, but full of sea-dreams
  • and the most charming anticipations of strange islands and adventures.
  • I brooded by the hour together over the map, all the details of which
  • I well remembered. Sitting by the fire in the housekeeper's room, I
  • approached that island in my fancy from every possible direction; I
  • explored every acre of its surface; I climbed a thousand times to that
  • tall hill they call the Spy-glass, and from the top enjoyed the most
  • wonderful and changing prospects. Sometimes the isle was thick with
  • savages, with whom we fought, sometimes full of dangerous animals that
  • hunted us, but in all my fancies nothing occurred to me so strange and
  • tragic as our actual adventures.
  • So the weeks passed on, till one fine day there came a letter addressed
  • to Dr. Livesey, with this addition, “To be opened, in the case of his
  • absence, by Tom Redruth or young Hawkins.” Obeying this order, we
  • found, or rather I found--for the gamekeeper was a poor hand at reading
  • anything but print--the following important news:
  • Old Anchor Inn, Bristol, March 1, 17--
  • Dear Livesey--As I do not know whether you
  • are at the hall or still in London, I send this in
  • double to both places.
  • The ship is bought and fitted. She lies at
  • anchor, ready for sea. You never imagined a
  • sweeter schooner--a child might sail her--two
  • hundred tons; name, HISPANIOLA.
  • I got her through my old friend, Blandly, who
  • has proved himself throughout the most surprising
  • trump. The admirable fellow literally slaved in
  • my interest, and so, I may say, did everyone in
  • Bristol, as soon as they got wind of the port we
  • sailed for--treasure, I mean.
  • “Redruth,” said I, interrupting the letter, “Dr. Livesey will not like
  • that. The squire has been talking, after all.”
  • “Well, who's a better right?” growled the gamekeeper. “A pretty rum go
  • if squire ain't to talk for Dr. Livesey, I should think.”
  • At that I gave up all attempts at commentary and read straight on:
  • Blandly himself found the HISPANIOLA, and
  • by the most admirable management got her for the
  • merest trifle. There is a class of men in Bristol
  • monstrously prejudiced against Blandly. They go
  • the length of declaring that this honest creature
  • would do anything for money, that the HISPANIOLA
  • belonged to him, and that he sold it me absurdly
  • high--the most transparent calumnies. None of them
  • dare, however, to deny the merits of the ship.
  • So far there was not a hitch. The
  • workpeople, to be sure--riggers and what not--were
  • most annoyingly slow; but time cured that. It was
  • the crew that troubled me.
  • I wished a round score of men--in case of
  • natives, buccaneers, or the odious French--and I
  • had the worry of the deuce itself to find so much
  • as half a dozen, till the most remarkable stroke
  • of fortune brought me the very man that I
  • required.
  • I was standing on the dock, when, by the
  • merest accident, I fell in talk with him. I found
  • he was an old sailor, kept a public-house, knew
  • all the seafaring men in Bristol, had lost his
  • health ashore, and wanted a good berth as cook to
  • get to sea again. He had hobbled down there that
  • morning, he said, to get a smell of the salt.
  • I was monstrously touched--so would you have
  • been--and, out of pure pity, I engaged him on the
  • spot to be ship's cook. Long John Silver, he is
  • called, and has lost a leg; but that I regarded as
  • a recommendation, since he lost it in his
  • country's service, under the immortal Hawke. He
  • has no pension, Livesey. Imagine the abominable
  • age we live in!
  • Well, sir, I thought I had only found a cook,
  • but it was a crew I had discovered. Between
  • Silver and myself we got together in a few days a
  • company of the toughest old salts imaginable--not
  • pretty to look at, but fellows, by their faces, of
  • the most indomitable spirit. I declare we could
  • fight a frigate.
  • Long John even got rid of two out of the six
  • or seven I had already engaged. He showed me in a
  • moment that they were just the sort of fresh-water
  • swabs we had to fear in an adventure of
  • importance.
  • I am in the most magnificent health and
  • spirits, eating like a bull, sleeping like a tree,
  • yet I shall not enjoy a moment till I hear my old
  • tarpaulins tramping round the capstan. Seaward,
  • ho! Hang the treasure! It's the glory of the sea
  • that has turned my head. So now, Livesey, come
  • post; do not lose an hour, if you respect me.
  • Let young Hawkins go at once to see his
  • mother, with Redruth for a guard; and then both
  • come full speed to Bristol.
  • John Trelawney
  • Postscript--I did not tell you that Blandly,
  • who, by the way, is to send a consort after us if
  • we don't turn up by the end of August, had found
  • an admirable fellow for sailing master--a stiff
  • man, which I regret, but in all other respects a
  • treasure. Long John Silver unearthed a very
  • competent man for a mate, a man named Arrow. I
  • have a boatswain who pipes, Livesey; so things
  • shall go man-o'-war fashion on board the good ship
  • HISPANIOLA.
  • I forgot to tell you that Silver is a man of
  • substance; I know of my own knowledge that he has
  • a banker's account, which has never been
  • overdrawn. He leaves his wife to manage the inn;
  • and as she is a woman of colour, a pair of old
  • bachelors like you and I may be excused for
  • guessing that it is the wife, quite as much as the
  • health, that sends him back to roving.
  • J. T.
  • P.P.S.--Hawkins may stay one night with his
  • mother.
  • J. T.
  • You can fancy the excitement into which that letter put me. I was half
  • beside myself with glee; and if ever I despised a man, it was old
  • Tom Redruth, who could do nothing but grumble and lament. Any of the
  • under-gamekeepers would gladly have changed places with him; but such
  • was not the squire's pleasure, and the squire's pleasure was like law
  • among them all. Nobody but old Redruth would have dared so much as even
  • to grumble.
  • The next morning he and I set out on foot for the Admiral Benbow, and
  • there I found my mother in good health and spirits. The captain, who had
  • so long been a cause of so much discomfort, was gone where the wicked
  • cease from troubling. The squire had had everything repaired, and the
  • public rooms and the sign repainted, and had added some furniture--above
  • all a beautiful armchair for mother in the bar. He had found her a boy
  • as an apprentice also so that she should not want help while I was gone.
  • It was on seeing that boy that I understood, for the first time, my
  • situation. I had thought up to that moment of the adventures before me,
  • not at all of the home that I was leaving; and now, at sight of this
  • clumsy stranger, who was to stay here in my place beside my mother, I
  • had my first attack of tears. I am afraid I led that boy a dog's life,
  • for as he was new to the work, I had a hundred opportunities of setting
  • him right and putting him down, and I was not slow to profit by them.
  • The night passed, and the next day, after dinner, Redruth and I were
  • afoot again and on the road. I said good-bye to Mother and the
  • cove where I had lived since I was born, and the dear old Admiral
  • Benbow--since he was repainted, no longer quite so dear. One of my last
  • thoughts was of the captain, who had so often strode along the beach
  • with his cocked hat, his sabre-cut cheek, and his old brass telescope.
  • Next moment we had turned the corner and my home was out of sight.
  • The mail picked us up about dusk at the Royal George on the heath. I was
  • wedged in between Redruth and a stout old gentleman, and in spite of the
  • swift motion and the cold night air, I must have dozed a great deal from
  • the very first, and then slept like a log up hill and down dale through
  • stage after stage, for when I was awakened at last it was by a punch
  • in the ribs, and I opened my eyes to find that we were standing still
  • before a large building in a city street and that the day had already
  • broken a long time.
  • “Where are we?” I asked.
  • “Bristol,” said Tom. “Get down.”
  • Mr. Trelawney had taken up his residence at an inn far down the docks to
  • superintend the work upon the schooner. Thither we had now to walk, and
  • our way, to my great delight, lay along the quays and beside the great
  • multitude of ships of all sizes and rigs and nations. In one, sailors
  • were singing at their work, in another there were men aloft, high over
  • my head, hanging to threads that seemed no thicker than a spider's.
  • Though I had lived by the shore all my life, I seemed never to have been
  • near the sea till then. The smell of tar and salt was something new.
  • I saw the most wonderful figureheads, that had all been far over the
  • ocean. I saw, besides, many old sailors, with rings in their ears, and
  • whiskers curled in ringlets, and tarry pigtails, and their swaggering,
  • clumsy sea-walk; and if I had seen as many kings or archbishops I could
  • not have been more delighted.
  • And I was going to sea myself, to sea in a schooner, with a piping
  • boatswain and pig-tailed singing seamen, to sea, bound for an unknown
  • island, and to seek for buried treasure!
  • While I was still in this delightful dream, we came suddenly in front
  • of a large inn and met Squire Trelawney, all dressed out like a
  • sea-officer, in stout blue cloth, coming out of the door with a smile on
  • his face and a capital imitation of a sailor's walk.
  • “Here you are,” he cried, “and the doctor came last night from London.
  • Bravo! The ship's company complete!”
  • “Oh, sir,” cried I, “when do we sail?”
  • “Sail!” says he. “We sail tomorrow!”
  • 8
  • At the Sign of the Spy-glass
  • WHEN I had done breakfasting the squire gave me a note addressed to John
  • Silver, at the sign of the Spy-glass, and told me I should easily
  • find the place by following the line of the docks and keeping a bright
  • lookout for a little tavern with a large brass telescope for sign. I
  • set off, overjoyed at this opportunity to see some more of the ships and
  • seamen, and picked my way among a great crowd of people and carts and
  • bales, for the dock was now at its busiest, until I found the tavern in
  • question.
  • It was a bright enough little place of entertainment. The sign was
  • newly painted; the windows had neat red curtains; the floor was cleanly
  • sanded. There was a street on each side and an open door on both, which
  • made the large, low room pretty clear to see in, in spite of clouds of
  • tobacco smoke.
  • The customers were mostly seafaring men, and they talked so loudly that
  • I hung at the door, almost afraid to enter.
  • As I was waiting, a man came out of a side room, and at a glance I was
  • sure he must be Long John. His left leg was cut off close by the hip,
  • and under the left shoulder he carried a crutch, which he managed with
  • wonderful dexterity, hopping about upon it like a bird. He was very tall
  • and strong, with a face as big as a ham--plain and pale, but intelligent
  • and smiling. Indeed, he seemed in the most cheerful spirits, whistling
  • as he moved about among the tables, with a merry word or a slap on the
  • shoulder for the more favoured of his guests.
  • Now, to tell you the truth, from the very first mention of Long John in
  • Squire Trelawney's letter I had taken a fear in my mind that he might
  • prove to be the very one-legged sailor whom I had watched for so long at
  • the old Benbow. But one look at the man before me was enough. I had seen
  • the captain, and Black Dog, and the blind man, Pew, and I thought I knew
  • what a buccaneer was like--a very different creature, according to me,
  • from this clean and pleasant-tempered landlord.
  • I plucked up courage at once, crossed the threshold, and walked right up
  • to the man where he stood, propped on his crutch, talking to a customer.
  • “Mr. Silver, sir?” I asked, holding out the note.
  • “Yes, my lad,” said he; “such is my name, to be sure. And who may you
  • be?” And then as he saw the squire's letter, he seemed to me to give
  • something almost like a start.
  • “Oh!” said he, quite loud, and offering his hand. “I see. You are our
  • new cabin-boy; pleased I am to see you.”
  • And he took my hand in his large firm grasp.
  • Just then one of the customers at the far side rose suddenly and made
  • for the door. It was close by him, and he was out in the street in a
  • moment. But his hurry had attracted my notice, and I recognized him at
  • glance. It was the tallow-faced man, wanting two fingers, who had come
  • first to the Admiral Benbow.
  • “Oh,” I cried, “stop him! It's Black Dog!”
  • “I don't care two coppers who he is,” cried Silver. “But he hasn't paid
  • his score. Harry, run and catch him.”
  • One of the others who was nearest the door leaped up and started in
  • pursuit.
  • “If he were Admiral Hawke he shall pay his score,” cried Silver; and
  • then, relinquishing my hand, “Who did you say he was?” he asked. “Black
  • what?”
  • “Dog, sir,” said I. “Has Mr. Trelawney not told you of the buccaneers?
  • He was one of them.”
  • “So?” cried Silver. “In my house! Ben, run and help Harry. One of those
  • swabs, was he? Was that you drinking with him, Morgan? Step up here.”
  • The man whom he called Morgan--an old, grey-haired, mahogany-faced
  • sailor--came forward pretty sheepishly, rolling his quid.
  • “Now, Morgan,” said Long John very sternly, “you never clapped your eyes
  • on that Black--Black Dog before, did you, now?”
  • “Not I, sir,” said Morgan with a salute.
  • “You didn't know his name, did you?”
  • “No, sir.”
  • “By the powers, Tom Morgan, it's as good for you!” exclaimed the
  • landlord. “If you had been mixed up with the like of that, you would
  • never have put another foot in my house, you may lay to that. And what
  • was he saying to you?”
  • “I don't rightly know, sir,” answered Morgan.
  • “Do you call that a head on your shoulders, or a blessed dead-eye?”
  • cried Long John. “Don't rightly know, don't you! Perhaps you don't
  • happen to rightly know who you was speaking to, perhaps? Come, now, what
  • was he jawing--v'yages, cap'ns, ships? Pipe up! What was it?”
  • “We was a-talkin' of keel-hauling,” answered Morgan.
  • “Keel-hauling, was you? And a mighty suitable thing, too, and you may
  • lay to that. Get back to your place for a lubber, Tom.”
  • And then, as Morgan rolled back to his seat, Silver added to me in a
  • confidential whisper that was very flattering, as I thought, “He's
  • quite an honest man, Tom Morgan, on'y stupid. And now,” he ran on again,
  • aloud, “let's see--Black Dog? No, I don't know the name, not I. Yet I
  • kind of think I've--yes, I've seen the swab. He used to come here with a
  • blind beggar, he used.”
  • “That he did, you may be sure,” said I. “I knew that blind man too. His
  • name was Pew.”
  • “It was!” cried Silver, now quite excited. “Pew! That were his name for
  • certain. Ah, he looked a shark, he did! If we run down this Black Dog,
  • now, there'll be news for Cap'n Trelawney! Ben's a good runner; few
  • seamen run better than Ben. He should run him down, hand over hand, by
  • the powers! He talked o' keel-hauling, did he? I'LL keel-haul him!”
  • All the time he was jerking out these phrases he was stumping up and
  • down the tavern on his crutch, slapping tables with his hand, and giving
  • such a show of excitement as would have convinced an Old Bailey judge
  • or a Bow Street runner. My suspicions had been thoroughly reawakened on
  • finding Black Dog at the Spy-glass, and I watched the cook narrowly. But
  • he was too deep, and too ready, and too clever for me, and by the time
  • the two men had come back out of breath and confessed that they had lost
  • the track in a crowd, and been scolded like thieves, I would have gone
  • bail for the innocence of Long John Silver.
  • “See here, now, Hawkins,” said he, “here's a blessed hard thing on a
  • man like me, now, ain't it? There's Cap'n Trelawney--what's he to think?
  • Here I have this confounded son of a Dutchman sitting in my own house
  • drinking of my own rum! Here you comes and tells me of it plain; and
  • here I let him give us all the slip before my blessed deadlights! Now,
  • Hawkins, you do me justice with the cap'n. You're a lad, you are, but
  • you're as smart as paint. I see that when you first come in. Now, here
  • it is: What could I do, with this old timber I hobble on? When I was an
  • A B master mariner I'd have come up alongside of him, hand over hand,
  • and broached him to in a brace of old shakes, I would; but now--”
  • And then, all of a sudden, he stopped, and his jaw dropped as though he
  • had remembered something.
  • “The score!” he burst out. “Three goes o' rum! Why, shiver my timbers,
  • if I hadn't forgotten my score!”
  • And falling on a bench, he laughed until the tears ran down his cheeks.
  • I could not help joining, and we laughed together, peal after peal,
  • until the tavern rang again.
  • “Why, what a precious old sea-calf I am!” he said at last, wiping his
  • cheeks. “You and me should get on well, Hawkins, for I'll take my davy
  • I should be rated ship's boy. But come now, stand by to go about. This
  • won't do. Dooty is dooty, messmates. I'll put on my old cockerel hat,
  • and step along of you to Cap'n Trelawney, and report this here affair.
  • For mind you, it's serious, young Hawkins; and neither you nor me's come
  • out of it with what I should make so bold as to call credit. Nor you
  • neither, says you; not smart--none of the pair of us smart. But dash my
  • buttons! That was a good un about my score.”
  • And he began to laugh again, and that so heartily, that though I did not
  • see the joke as he did, I was again obliged to join him in his mirth.
  • On our little walk along the quays, he made himself the most interesting
  • companion, telling me about the different ships that we passed by,
  • their rig, tonnage, and nationality, explaining the work that was going
  • forward--how one was discharging, another taking in cargo, and a third
  • making ready for sea--and every now and then telling me some little
  • anecdote of ships or seamen or repeating a nautical phrase till I had
  • learned it perfectly. I began to see that here was one of the best of
  • possible shipmates.
  • When we got to the inn, the squire and Dr. Livesey were seated together,
  • finishing a quart of ale with a toast in it, before they should go
  • aboard the schooner on a visit of inspection.
  • Long John told the story from first to last, with a great deal of spirit
  • and the most perfect truth. “That was how it were, now, weren't it,
  • Hawkins?” he would say, now and again, and I could always bear him
  • entirely out.
  • The two gentlemen regretted that Black Dog had got away, but we all
  • agreed there was nothing to be done, and after he had been complimented,
  • Long John took up his crutch and departed.
  • “All hands aboard by four this afternoon,” shouted the squire after him.
  • “Aye, aye, sir,” cried the cook, in the passage.
  • “Well, squire,” said Dr. Livesey, “I don't put much faith in your
  • discoveries, as a general thing; but I will say this, John Silver suits
  • me.”
  • “The man's a perfect trump,” declared the squire.
  • “And now,” added the doctor, “Jim may come on board with us, may he
  • not?”
  • “To be sure he may,” says squire. “Take your hat, Hawkins, and we'll see
  • the ship.”
  • 9
  • Powder and Arms
  • THE HISPANIOLA lay some way out, and we went under the figureheads and
  • round the sterns of many other ships, and their cables sometimes grated
  • underneath our keel, and sometimes swung above us. At last, however,
  • we got alongside, and were met and saluted as we stepped aboard by the
  • mate, Mr. Arrow, a brown old sailor with earrings in his ears and a
  • squint. He and the squire were very thick and friendly, but I soon
  • observed that things were not the same between Mr. Trelawney and the
  • captain.
  • This last was a sharp-looking man who seemed angry with everything on
  • board and was soon to tell us why, for we had hardly got down into the
  • cabin when a sailor followed us.
  • “Captain Smollett, sir, axing to speak with you,” said he.
  • “I am always at the captain's orders. Show him in,” said the squire.
  • The captain, who was close behind his messenger, entered at once and
  • shut the door behind him.
  • “Well, Captain Smollett, what have you to say? All well, I hope; all
  • shipshape and seaworthy?”
  • “Well, sir,” said the captain, “better speak plain, I believe, even at
  • the risk of offence. I don't like this cruise; I don't like the men; and
  • I don't like my officer. That's short and sweet.”
  • “Perhaps, sir, you don't like the ship?” inquired the squire, very
  • angry, as I could see.
  • “I can't speak as to that, sir, not having seen her tried,” said the
  • captain. “She seems a clever craft; more I can't say.”
  • “Possibly, sir, you may not like your employer, either?” says the
  • squire.
  • But here Dr. Livesey cut in.
  • “Stay a bit,” said he, “stay a bit. No use of such questions as that but
  • to produce ill feeling. The captain has said too much or he has said too
  • little, and I'm bound to say that I require an explanation of his words.
  • You don't, you say, like this cruise. Now, why?”
  • “I was engaged, sir, on what we call sealed orders, to sail this ship
  • for that gentleman where he should bid me,” said the captain. “So far
  • so good. But now I find that every man before the mast knows more than I
  • do. I don't call that fair, now, do you?”
  • “No,” said Dr. Livesey, “I don't.”
  • “Next,” said the captain, “I learn we are going after treasure--hear
  • it from my own hands, mind you. Now, treasure is ticklish work; I don't
  • like treasure voyages on any account, and I don't like them, above all,
  • when they are secret and when (begging your pardon, Mr. Trelawney) the
  • secret has been told to the parrot.”
  • “Silver's parrot?” asked the squire.
  • “It's a way of speaking,” said the captain. “Blabbed, I mean. It's my
  • belief neither of you gentlemen know what you are about, but I'll tell
  • you my way of it--life or death, and a close run.”
  • “That is all clear, and, I dare say, true enough,” replied Dr. Livesey.
  • “We take the risk, but we are not so ignorant as you believe us. Next,
  • you say you don't like the crew. Are they not good seamen?”
  • “I don't like them, sir,” returned Captain Smollett. “And I think I
  • should have had the choosing of my own hands, if you go to that.”
  • “Perhaps you should,” replied the doctor. “My friend should, perhaps,
  • have taken you along with him; but the slight, if there be one, was
  • unintentional. And you don't like Mr. Arrow?”
  • “I don't, sir. I believe he's a good seaman, but he's too free with
  • the crew to be a good officer. A mate should keep himself to
  • himself--shouldn't drink with the men before the mast!”
  • “Do you mean he drinks?” cried the squire.
  • “No, sir,” replied the captain, “only that he's too familiar.”
  • “Well, now, and the short and long of it, captain?” asked the doctor.
  • “Tell us what you want.”
  • “Well, gentlemen, are you determined to go on this cruise?”
  • “Like iron,” answered the squire.
  • “Very good,” said the captain. “Then, as you've heard me very patiently,
  • saying things that I could not prove, hear me a few words more. They are
  • putting the powder and the arms in the fore hold. Now, you have a good
  • place under the cabin; why not put them there?--first point. Then, you
  • are bringing four of your own people with you, and they tell me some of
  • them are to be berthed forward. Why not give them the berths here beside
  • the cabin?--second point.”
  • “Any more?” asked Mr. Trelawney.
  • “One more,” said the captain. “There's been too much blabbing already.”
  • “Far too much,” agreed the doctor.
  • “I'll tell you what I've heard myself,” continued Captain Smollett:
  • “that you have a map of an island, that there's crosses on the map to
  • show where treasure is, and that the island lies--” And then he named
  • the latitude and longitude exactly.
  • “I never told that,” cried the squire, “to a soul!”
  • “The hands know it, sir,” returned the captain.
  • “Livesey, that must have been you or Hawkins,” cried the squire.
  • “It doesn't much matter who it was,” replied the doctor. And I could
  • see that neither he nor the captain paid much regard to Mr. Trelawney's
  • protestations. Neither did I, to be sure, he was so loose a talker; yet
  • in this case I believe he was really right and that nobody had told the
  • situation of the island.
  • “Well, gentlemen,” continued the captain, “I don't know who has this
  • map; but I make it a point, it shall be kept secret even from me and Mr.
  • Arrow. Otherwise I would ask you to let me resign.”
  • “I see,” said the doctor. “You wish us to keep this matter dark and to
  • make a garrison of the stern part of the ship, manned with my friend's
  • own people, and provided with all the arms and powder on board. In other
  • words, you fear a mutiny.”
  • “Sir,” said Captain Smollett, “with no intention to take offence, I
  • deny your right to put words into my mouth. No captain, sir, would be
  • justified in going to sea at all if he had ground enough to say that. As
  • for Mr. Arrow, I believe him thoroughly honest; some of the men are the
  • same; all may be for what I know. But I am responsible for the ship's
  • safety and the life of every man Jack aboard of her. I see things going,
  • as I think, not quite right. And I ask you to take certain precautions
  • or let me resign my berth. And that's all.”
  • “Captain Smollett,” began the doctor with a smile, “did ever you hear
  • the fable of the mountain and the mouse? You'll excuse me, I dare say,
  • but you remind me of that fable. When you came in here, I'll stake my
  • wig, you meant more than this.”
  • “Doctor,” said the captain, “you are smart. When I came in here I meant
  • to get discharged. I had no thought that Mr. Trelawney would hear a
  • word.”
  • “No more I would,” cried the squire. “Had Livesey not been here I should
  • have seen you to the deuce. As it is, I have heard you. I will do as you
  • desire, but I think the worse of you.”
  • “That's as you please, sir,” said the captain. “You'll find I do my
  • duty.”
  • And with that he took his leave.
  • “Trelawney,” said the doctor, “contrary to all my notions, I believed
  • you have managed to get two honest men on board with you--that man and
  • John Silver.”
  • “Silver, if you like,” cried the squire; “but as for that intolerable
  • humbug, I declare I think his conduct unmanly, unsailorly, and downright
  • un-English.”
  • “Well,” says the doctor, “we shall see.”
  • When we came on deck, the men had begun already to take out the arms and
  • powder, yo-ho-ing at their work, while the captain and Mr. Arrow stood
  • by superintending.
  • The new arrangement was quite to my liking. The whole schooner had been
  • overhauled; six berths had been made astern out of what had been the
  • after-part of the main hold; and this set of cabins was only joined to
  • the galley and forecastle by a sparred passage on the port side. It had
  • been originally meant that the captain, Mr. Arrow, Hunter, Joyce, the
  • doctor, and the squire were to occupy these six berths. Now Redruth and
  • I were to get two of them and Mr. Arrow and the captain were to sleep
  • on deck in the companion, which had been enlarged on each side till you
  • might almost have called it a round-house. Very low it was still, of
  • course; but there was room to swing two hammocks, and even the mate
  • seemed pleased with the arrangement. Even he, perhaps, had been doubtful
  • as to the crew, but that is only guess, for as you shall hear, we had
  • not long the benefit of his opinion.
  • We were all hard at work, changing the powder and the berths, when
  • the last man or two, and Long John along with them, came off in a
  • shore-boat.
  • The cook came up the side like a monkey for cleverness, and as soon as
  • he saw what was doing, “So ho, mates!” says he. “What's this?”
  • “We're a-changing of the powder, Jack,” answers one.
  • “Why, by the powers,” cried Long John, “if we do, we'll miss the morning
  • tide!”
  • “My orders!” said the captain shortly. “You may go below, my man. Hands
  • will want supper.”
  • “Aye, aye, sir,” answered the cook, and touching his forelock, he
  • disappeared at once in the direction of his galley.
  • “That's a good man, captain,” said the doctor.
  • “Very likely, sir,” replied Captain Smollett. “Easy with that,
  • men--easy,” he ran on, to the fellows who were shifting the powder; and
  • then suddenly observing me examining the swivel we carried amidships,
  • a long brass nine, “Here you, ship's boy,” he cried, “out o' that! Off
  • with you to the cook and get some work.”
  • And then as I was hurrying off I heard him say, quite loudly, to the
  • doctor, “I'll have no favourites on my ship.”
  • I assure you I was quite of the squire's way of thinking, and hated the
  • captain deeply.
  • 10
  • The Voyage
  • ALL that night we were in a great bustle getting things stowed in their
  • place, and boatfuls of the squire's friends, Mr. Blandly and the like,
  • coming off to wish him a good voyage and a safe return. We never had
  • a night at the Admiral Benbow when I had half the work; and I was
  • dog-tired when, a little before dawn, the boatswain sounded his pipe
  • and the crew began to man the capstan-bars. I might have been twice
  • as weary, yet I would not have left the deck, all was so new and
  • interesting to me--the brief commands, the shrill note of the whistle,
  • the men bustling to their places in the glimmer of the ship's lanterns.
  • “Now, Barbecue, tip us a stave,” cried one voice.
  • “The old one,” cried another.
  • “Aye, aye, mates,” said Long John, who was standing by, with his crutch
  • under his arm, and at once broke out in the air and words I knew so
  • well:
  • “Fifteen men on the dead man's chest--”
  • And then the whole crew bore chorus:--
  • “Yo-ho-ho, and a bottle of rum!”
  • And at the third “Ho!” drove the bars before them with a will.
  • Even at that exciting moment it carried me back to the old Admiral
  • Benbow in a second, and I seemed to hear the voice of the captain piping
  • in the chorus. But soon the anchor was short up; soon it was hanging
  • dripping at the bows; soon the sails began to draw, and the land and
  • shipping to flit by on either side; and before I could lie down to
  • snatch an hour of slumber the HISPANIOLA had begun her voyage to the
  • Isle of Treasure.
  • I am not going to relate that voyage in detail. It was fairly
  • prosperous. The ship proved to be a good ship, the crew were capable
  • seamen, and the captain thoroughly understood his business. But before
  • we came the length of Treasure Island, two or three things had happened
  • which require to be known.
  • Mr. Arrow, first of all, turned out even worse than the captain had
  • feared. He had no command among the men, and people did what they
  • pleased with him. But that was by no means the worst of it, for after a
  • day or two at sea he began to appear on deck with hazy eye, red cheeks,
  • stuttering tongue, and other marks of drunkenness. Time after time
  • he was ordered below in disgrace. Sometimes he fell and cut himself;
  • sometimes he lay all day long in his little bunk at one side of the
  • companion; sometimes for a day or two he would be almost sober and
  • attend to his work at least passably.
  • In the meantime, we could never make out where he got the drink. That
  • was the ship's mystery. Watch him as we pleased, we could do nothing to
  • solve it; and when we asked him to his face, he would only laugh if
  • he were drunk, and if he were sober deny solemnly that he ever tasted
  • anything but water.
  • He was not only useless as an officer and a bad influence amongst
  • the men, but it was plain that at this rate he must soon kill himself
  • outright, so nobody was much surprised, nor very sorry, when one dark
  • night, with a head sea, he disappeared entirely and was seen no more.
  • “Overboard!” said the captain. “Well, gentlemen, that saves the trouble
  • of putting him in irons.”
  • But there we were, without a mate; and it was necessary, of course, to
  • advance one of the men. The boatswain, Job Anderson, was the likeliest
  • man aboard, and though he kept his old title, he served in a way as
  • mate. Mr. Trelawney had followed the sea, and his knowledge made him
  • very useful, for he often took a watch himself in easy weather. And the
  • coxswain, Israel Hands, was a careful, wily, old, experienced seaman who
  • could be trusted at a pinch with almost anything.
  • He was a great confidant of Long John Silver, and so the mention of
  • his name leads me on to speak of our ship's cook, Barbecue, as the men
  • called him.
  • Aboard ship he carried his crutch by a lanyard round his neck, to have
  • both hands as free as possible. It was something to see him wedge the
  • foot of the crutch against a bulkhead, and propped against it, yielding
  • to every movement of the ship, get on with his cooking like someone safe
  • ashore. Still more strange was it to see him in the heaviest of weather
  • cross the deck. He had a line or two rigged up to help him across the
  • widest spaces--Long John's earrings, they were called; and he would hand
  • himself from one place to another, now using the crutch, now trailing it
  • alongside by the lanyard, as quickly as another man could walk. Yet some
  • of the men who had sailed with him before expressed their pity to see
  • him so reduced.
  • “He's no common man, Barbecue,” said the coxswain to me. “He had good
  • schooling in his young days and can speak like a book when so minded;
  • and brave--a lion's nothing alongside of Long John! I seen him grapple
  • four and knock their heads together--him unarmed.”
  • All the crew respected and even obeyed him. He had a way of talking
  • to each and doing everybody some particular service. To me he was
  • unweariedly kind, and always glad to see me in the galley, which he kept
  • as clean as a new pin, the dishes hanging up burnished and his parrot in
  • a cage in one corner.
  • “Come away, Hawkins,” he would say; “come and have a yarn with John.
  • Nobody more welcome than yourself, my son. Sit you down and hear the
  • news. Here's Cap'n Flint--I calls my parrot Cap'n Flint, after the
  • famous buccaneer--here's Cap'n Flint predicting success to our v'yage.
  • Wasn't you, cap'n?”
  • And the parrot would say, with great rapidity, “Pieces of eight! Pieces
  • of eight! Pieces of eight!” till you wondered that it was not out of
  • breath, or till John threw his handkerchief over the cage.
  • “Now, that bird,” he would say, “is, maybe, two hundred years
  • old, Hawkins--they live forever mostly; and if anybody's seen more
  • wickedness, it must be the devil himself. She's sailed with England,
  • the great Cap'n England, the pirate. She's been at Madagascar, and at
  • Malabar, and Surinam, and Providence, and Portobello. She was at the
  • fishing up of the wrecked plate ships. It's there she learned 'Pieces
  • of eight,' and little wonder; three hundred and fifty thousand of 'em,
  • Hawkins! She was at the boarding of the viceroy of the Indies out of
  • Goa, she was; and to look at her you would think she was a babby. But
  • you smelt powder--didn't you, cap'n?”
  • “Stand by to go about,” the parrot would scream.
  • “Ah, she's a handsome craft, she is,” the cook would say, and give her
  • sugar from his pocket, and then the bird would peck at the bars and
  • swear straight on, passing belief for wickedness. “There,” John would
  • add, “you can't touch pitch and not be mucked, lad. Here's this poor old
  • innocent bird o' mine swearing blue fire, and none the wiser, you may
  • lay to that. She would swear the same, in a manner of speaking, before
  • chaplain.” And John would touch his forelock with a solemn way he had
  • that made me think he was the best of men.
  • In the meantime, the squire and Captain Smollett were still on pretty
  • distant terms with one another. The squire made no bones about the
  • matter; he despised the captain. The captain, on his part, never spoke
  • but when he was spoken to, and then sharp and short and dry, and not a
  • word wasted. He owned, when driven into a corner, that he seemed to have
  • been wrong about the crew, that some of them were as brisk as he wanted
  • to see and all had behaved fairly well. As for the ship, he had taken a
  • downright fancy to her. “She'll lie a point nearer the wind than a man
  • has a right to expect of his own married wife, sir. But,” he would add,
  • “all I say is, we're not home again, and I don't like the cruise.”
  • The squire, at this, would turn away and march up and down the deck,
  • chin in air.
  • “A trifle more of that man,” he would say, “and I shall explode.”
  • We had some heavy weather, which only proved the qualities of the
  • HISPANIOLA. Every man on board seemed well content, and they must have
  • been hard to please if they had been otherwise, for it is my belief
  • there was never a ship's company so spoiled since Noah put to sea.
  • Double grog was going on the least excuse; there was duff on odd days,
  • as, for instance, if the squire heard it was any man's birthday, and
  • always a barrel of apples standing broached in the waist for anyone to
  • help himself that had a fancy.
  • “Never knew good come of it yet,” the captain said to Dr. Livesey.
  • “Spoil forecastle hands, make devils. That's my belief.”
  • But good did come of the apple barrel, as you shall hear, for if it had
  • not been for that, we should have had no note of warning and might all
  • have perished by the hand of treachery.
  • This was how it came about.
  • We had run up the trades to get the wind of the island we were after--I
  • am not allowed to be more plain--and now we were running down for it
  • with a bright lookout day and night. It was about the last day of our
  • outward voyage by the largest computation; some time that night, or at
  • latest before noon of the morrow, we should sight the Treasure Island.
  • We were heading S.S.W. and had a steady breeze abeam and a quiet sea.
  • The HISPANIOLA rolled steadily, dipping her bowsprit now and then with
  • a whiff of spray. All was drawing alow and aloft; everyone was in the
  • bravest spirits because we were now so near an end of the first part of
  • our adventure.
  • Now, just after sundown, when all my work was over and I was on my way
  • to my berth, it occurred to me that I should like an apple. I ran on
  • deck. The watch was all forward looking out for the island. The man at
  • the helm was watching the luff of the sail and whistling away gently
  • to himself, and that was the only sound excepting the swish of the sea
  • against the bows and around the sides of the ship.
  • In I got bodily into the apple barrel, and found there was scarce an
  • apple left; but sitting down there in the dark, what with the sound of
  • the waters and the rocking movement of the ship, I had either fallen
  • asleep or was on the point of doing so when a heavy man sat down with
  • rather a clash close by. The barrel shook as he leaned his shoulders
  • against it, and I was just about to jump up when the man began to speak.
  • It was Silver's voice, and before I had heard a dozen words, I would
  • not have shown myself for all the world, but lay there, trembling and
  • listening, in the extreme of fear and curiosity, for from these dozen
  • words I understood that the lives of all the honest men aboard depended
  • upon me alone.
  • 11
  • What I Heard in the Apple Barrel
  • “NO, not I,” said Silver. “Flint was cap'n; I was quartermaster, along
  • of my timber leg. The same broadside I lost my leg, old Pew lost his
  • deadlights. It was a master surgeon, him that ampytated me--out of
  • college and all--Latin by the bucket, and what not; but he was hanged
  • like a dog, and sun-dried like the rest, at Corso Castle. That
  • was Roberts' men, that was, and comed of changing names to their
  • ships--ROYAL FORTUNE and so on. Now, what a ship was christened, so let
  • her stay, I says. So it was with the CASSANDRA, as brought us all safe
  • home from Malabar, after England took the viceroy of the Indies; so it
  • was with the old WALRUS, Flint's old ship, as I've seen amuck with the
  • red blood and fit to sink with gold.”
  • “Ah!” cried another voice, that of the youngest hand on board, and
  • evidently full of admiration. “He was the flower of the flock, was
  • Flint!”
  • “Davis was a man too, by all accounts,” said Silver. “I never sailed
  • along of him; first with England, then with Flint, that's my story;
  • and now here on my own account, in a manner of speaking. I laid by nine
  • hundred safe, from England, and two thousand after Flint. That ain't bad
  • for a man before the mast--all safe in bank. 'Tain't earning now, it's
  • saving does it, you may lay to that. Where's all England's men now? I
  • dunno. Where's Flint's? Why, most on 'em aboard here, and glad to get
  • the duff--been begging before that, some on 'em. Old Pew, as had lost
  • his sight, and might have thought shame, spends twelve hundred pound in
  • a year, like a lord in Parliament. Where is he now? Well, he's dead now
  • and under hatches; but for two year before that, shiver my timbers,
  • the man was starving! He begged, and he stole, and he cut throats, and
  • starved at that, by the powers!”
  • “Well, it ain't much use, after all,” said the young seaman.
  • “'Tain't much use for fools, you may lay to it--that, nor nothing,”
  • cried Silver. “But now, you look here: you're young, you are, but you're
  • as smart as paint. I see that when I set my eyes on you, and I'll talk
  • to you like a man.”
  • You may imagine how I felt when I heard this abominable old rogue
  • addressing another in the very same words of flattery as he had used
  • to myself. I think, if I had been able, that I would have killed
  • him through the barrel. Meantime, he ran on, little supposing he was
  • overheard.
  • “Here it is about gentlemen of fortune. They lives rough, and they risk
  • swinging, but they eat and drink like fighting-cocks, and when a cruise
  • is done, why, it's hundreds of pounds instead of hundreds of farthings
  • in their pockets. Now, the most goes for rum and a good fling, and to
  • sea again in their shirts. But that's not the course I lay. I puts it
  • all away, some here, some there, and none too much anywheres, by reason
  • of suspicion. I'm fifty, mark you; once back from this cruise, I set up
  • gentleman in earnest. Time enough too, says you. Ah, but I've lived easy
  • in the meantime, never denied myself o' nothing heart desires, and slep'
  • soft and ate dainty all my days but when at sea. And how did I begin?
  • Before the mast, like you!”
  • “Well,” said the other, “but all the other money's gone now, ain't it?
  • You daren't show face in Bristol after this.”
  • “Why, where might you suppose it was?” asked Silver derisively.
  • “At Bristol, in banks and places,” answered his companion.
  • “It were,” said the cook; “it were when we weighed anchor. But my old
  • missis has it all by now. And the Spy-glass is sold, lease and goodwill
  • and rigging; and the old girl's off to meet me. I would tell you where,
  • for I trust you, but it'd make jealousy among the mates.”
  • “And can you trust your missis?” asked the other.
  • “Gentlemen of fortune,” returned the cook, “usually trusts little among
  • themselves, and right they are, you may lay to it. But I have a way with
  • me, I have. When a mate brings a slip on his cable--one as knows me, I
  • mean--it won't be in the same world with old John. There was some that
  • was feared of Pew, and some that was feared of Flint; but Flint his own
  • self was feared of me. Feared he was, and proud. They was the roughest
  • crew afloat, was Flint's; the devil himself would have been feared to go
  • to sea with them. Well now, I tell you, I'm not a boasting man, and you
  • seen yourself how easy I keep company, but when I was quartermaster,
  • LAMBS wasn't the word for Flint's old buccaneers. Ah, you may be sure of
  • yourself in old John's ship.”
  • “Well, I tell you now,” replied the lad, “I didn't half a quarter like
  • the job till I had this talk with you, John; but there's my hand on it
  • now.”
  • “And a brave lad you were, and smart too,” answered Silver, shaking
  • hands so heartily that all the barrel shook, “and a finer figurehead for
  • a gentleman of fortune I never clapped my eyes on.”
  • By this time I had begun to understand the meaning of their terms. By a
  • “gentleman of fortune” they plainly meant neither more nor less than a
  • common pirate, and the little scene that I had overheard was the last
  • act in the corruption of one of the honest hands--perhaps of the last
  • one left aboard. But on this point I was soon to be relieved, for Silver
  • giving a little whistle, a third man strolled up and sat down by the
  • party.
  • “Dick's square,” said Silver.
  • “Oh, I know'd Dick was square,” returned the voice of the coxswain,
  • Israel Hands. “He's no fool, is Dick.” And he turned his quid and spat.
  • “But look here,” he went on, “here's what I want to know, Barbecue: how
  • long are we a-going to stand off and on like a blessed bumboat? I've had
  • a'most enough o' Cap'n Smollett; he's hazed me long enough, by thunder!
  • I want to go into that cabin, I do. I want their pickles and wines, and
  • that.”
  • “Israel,” said Silver, “your head ain't much account, nor ever was. But
  • you're able to hear, I reckon; leastways, your ears is big enough.
  • Now, here's what I say: you'll berth forward, and you'll live hard, and
  • you'll speak soft, and you'll keep sober till I give the word; and you
  • may lay to that, my son.”
  • “Well, I don't say no, do I?” growled the coxswain. “What I say is,
  • when? That's what I say.”
  • “When! By the powers!” cried Silver. “Well now, if you want to know,
  • I'll tell you when. The last moment I can manage, and that's when.
  • Here's a first-rate seaman, Cap'n Smollett, sails the blessed ship for
  • us. Here's this squire and doctor with a map and such--I don't know
  • where it is, do I? No more do you, says you. Well then, I mean this
  • squire and doctor shall find the stuff, and help us to get it aboard,
  • by the powers. Then we'll see. If I was sure of you all, sons of double
  • Dutchmen, I'd have Cap'n Smollett navigate us half-way back again before
  • I struck.”
  • “Why, we're all seamen aboard here, I should think,” said the lad Dick.
  • “We're all forecastle hands, you mean,” snapped Silver. “We can steer
  • a course, but who's to set one? That's what all you gentlemen split on,
  • first and last. If I had my way, I'd have Cap'n Smollett work us back
  • into the trades at least; then we'd have no blessed miscalculations and
  • a spoonful of water a day. But I know the sort you are. I'll finish with
  • 'em at the island, as soon's the blunt's on board, and a pity it is. But
  • you're never happy till you're drunk. Split my sides, I've a sick heart
  • to sail with the likes of you!”
  • “Easy all, Long John,” cried Israel. “Who's a-crossin' of you?”
  • “Why, how many tall ships, think ye, now, have I seen laid aboard? And
  • how many brisk lads drying in the sun at Execution Dock?” cried Silver.
  • “And all for this same hurry and hurry and hurry. You hear me? I seen
  • a thing or two at sea, I have. If you would on'y lay your course, and a
  • p'int to windward, you would ride in carriages, you would. But not you!
  • I know you. You'll have your mouthful of rum tomorrow, and go hang.”
  • “Everybody knowed you was a kind of a chapling, John; but there's others
  • as could hand and steer as well as you,” said Israel. “They liked a bit
  • o' fun, they did. They wasn't so high and dry, nohow, but took their
  • fling, like jolly companions every one.”
  • “So?” says Silver. “Well, and where are they now? Pew was that sort,
  • and he died a beggar-man. Flint was, and he died of rum at Savannah. Ah,
  • they was a sweet crew, they was! On'y, where are they?”
  • “But,” asked Dick, “when we do lay 'em athwart, what are we to do with
  • 'em, anyhow?”
  • “There's the man for me!” cried the cook admiringly. “That's what I call
  • business. Well, what would you think? Put 'em ashore like maroons? That
  • would have been England's way. Or cut 'em down like that much pork? That
  • would have been Flint's, or Billy Bones's.”
  • “Billy was the man for that,” said Israel. “'Dead men don't bite,' says
  • he. Well, he's dead now hisself; he knows the long and short on it now;
  • and if ever a rough hand come to port, it was Billy.”
  • “Right you are,” said Silver; “rough and ready. But mark you here,
  • I'm an easy man--I'm quite the gentleman, says you; but this time it's
  • serious. Dooty is dooty, mates. I give my vote--death. When I'm in
  • Parlyment and riding in my coach, I don't want none of these sea-lawyers
  • in the cabin a-coming home, unlooked for, like the devil at prayers.
  • Wait is what I say; but when the time comes, why, let her rip!”
  • “John,” cries the coxswain, “you're a man!”
  • “You'll say so, Israel when you see,” said Silver. “Only one thing I
  • claim--I claim Trelawney. I'll wring his calf's head off his body with
  • these hands, Dick!” he added, breaking off. “You just jump up, like a
  • sweet lad, and get me an apple, to wet my pipe like.”
  • You may fancy the terror I was in! I should have leaped out and run for
  • it if I had found the strength, but my limbs and heart alike misgave me.
  • I heard Dick begin to rise, and then someone seemingly stopped him, and
  • the voice of Hands exclaimed, “Oh, stow that! Don't you get sucking of
  • that bilge, John. Let's have a go of the rum.”
  • “Dick,” said Silver, “I trust you. I've a gauge on the keg, mind.
  • There's the key; you fill a pannikin and bring it up.”
  • Terrified as I was, I could not help thinking to myself that this must
  • have been how Mr. Arrow got the strong waters that destroyed him.
  • Dick was gone but a little while, and during his absence Israel spoke
  • straight on in the cook's ear. It was but a word or two that I could
  • catch, and yet I gathered some important news, for besides other scraps
  • that tended to the same purpose, this whole clause was audible: “Not
  • another man of them'll jine.” Hence there were still faithful men on
  • board.
  • When Dick returned, one after another of the trio took the pannikin and
  • drank--one “To luck,” another with a “Here's to old Flint,” and Silver
  • himself saying, in a kind of song, “Here's to ourselves, and hold your
  • luff, plenty of prizes and plenty of duff.”
  • Just then a sort of brightness fell upon me in the barrel, and looking
  • up, I found the moon had risen and was silvering the mizzen-top and
  • shining white on the luff of the fore-sail; and almost at the same time
  • the voice of the lookout shouted, “Land ho!”
  • 12
  • Council of War
  • THERE was a great rush of feet across the deck. I could hear people
  • tumbling up from the cabin and the forecastle, and slipping in an
  • instant outside my barrel, I dived behind the fore-sail, made a double
  • towards the stern, and came out upon the open deck in time to join
  • Hunter and Dr. Livesey in the rush for the weather bow.
  • There all hands were already congregated. A belt of fog had lifted
  • almost simultaneously with the appearance of the moon. Away to the
  • south-west of us we saw two low hills, about a couple of miles apart,
  • and rising behind one of them a third and higher hill, whose peak was
  • still buried in the fog. All three seemed sharp and conical in figure.
  • So much I saw, almost in a dream, for I had not yet recovered from my
  • horrid fear of a minute or two before. And then I heard the voice of
  • Captain Smollett issuing orders. The HISPANIOLA was laid a couple of
  • points nearer the wind and now sailed a course that would just clear the
  • island on the east.
  • “And now, men,” said the captain, when all was sheeted home, “has any
  • one of you ever seen that land ahead?”
  • “I have, sir,” said Silver. “I've watered there with a trader I was cook
  • in.”
  • “The anchorage is on the south, behind an islet, I fancy?” asked the
  • captain.
  • “Yes, sir; Skeleton Island they calls it. It were a main place for
  • pirates once, and a hand we had on board knowed all their names for it.
  • That hill to the nor'ard they calls the Fore-mast Hill; there are three
  • hills in a row running south'ard--fore, main, and mizzen, sir. But the
  • main--that's the big un, with the cloud on it--they usually calls
  • the Spy-glass, by reason of a lookout they kept when they was in the
  • anchorage cleaning, for it's there they cleaned their ships, sir, asking
  • your pardon.”
  • “I have a chart here,” says Captain Smollett. “See if that's the place.”
  • Long John's eyes burned in his head as he took the chart, but by the
  • fresh look of the paper I knew he was doomed to disappointment. This
  • was not the map we found in Billy Bones's chest, but an accurate copy,
  • complete in all things--names and heights and soundings--with the single
  • exception of the red crosses and the written notes. Sharp as must have
  • been his annoyance, Silver had the strength of mind to hide it.
  • “Yes, sir,” said he, “this is the spot, to be sure, and very prettily
  • drawed out. Who might have done that, I wonder? The pirates were too
  • ignorant, I reckon. Aye, here it is: 'Capt. Kidd's Anchorage'--just
  • the name my shipmate called it. There's a strong current runs along the
  • south, and then away nor'ard up the west coast. Right you was, sir,”
  • says he, “to haul your wind and keep the weather of the island.
  • Leastways, if such was your intention as to enter and careen, and there
  • ain't no better place for that in these waters.”
  • “Thank you, my man,” says Captain Smollett. “I'll ask you later on to
  • give us a help. You may go.”
  • I was surprised at the coolness with which John avowed his knowledge
  • of the island, and I own I was half-frightened when I saw him drawing
  • nearer to myself. He did not know, to be sure, that I had overheard his
  • council from the apple barrel, and yet I had by this time taken such a
  • horror of his cruelty, duplicity, and power that I could scarce conceal
  • a shudder when he laid his hand upon my arm.
  • “Ah,” says he, “this here is a sweet spot, this island--a sweet spot for
  • a lad to get ashore on. You'll bathe, and you'll climb trees, and you'll
  • hunt goats, you will; and you'll get aloft on them hills like a goat
  • yourself. Why, it makes me young again. I was going to forget my timber
  • leg, I was. It's a pleasant thing to be young and have ten toes, and you
  • may lay to that. When you want to go a bit of exploring, you just ask
  • old John, and he'll put up a snack for you to take along.”
  • And clapping me in the friendliest way upon the shoulder, he hobbled off
  • forward and went below.
  • Captain Smollett, the squire, and Dr. Livesey were talking together on
  • the quarter-deck, and anxious as I was to tell them my story, I durst
  • not interrupt them openly. While I was still casting about in my
  • thoughts to find some probable excuse, Dr. Livesey called me to his
  • side. He had left his pipe below, and being a slave to tobacco, had
  • meant that I should fetch it; but as soon as I was near enough to speak
  • and not to be overheard, I broke immediately, “Doctor, let me speak. Get
  • the captain and squire down to the cabin, and then make some pretence to
  • send for me. I have terrible news.”
  • The doctor changed countenance a little, but next moment he was master
  • of himself.
  • “Thank you, Jim,” said he quite loudly, “that was all I wanted to know,”
  • as if he had asked me a question.
  • And with that he turned on his heel and rejoined the other two. They
  • spoke together for a little, and though none of them started, or raised
  • his voice, or so much as whistled, it was plain enough that Dr. Livesey
  • had communicated my request, for the next thing that I heard was the
  • captain giving an order to Job Anderson, and all hands were piped on
  • deck.
  • “My lads,” said Captain Smollett, “I've a word to say to you. This
  • land that we have sighted is the place we have been sailing for. Mr.
  • Trelawney, being a very open-handed gentleman, as we all know, has just
  • asked me a word or two, and as I was able to tell him that every man on
  • board had done his duty, alow and aloft, as I never ask to see it done
  • better, why, he and I and the doctor are going below to the cabin to
  • drink YOUR health and luck, and you'll have grog served out for you to
  • drink OUR health and luck. I'll tell you what I think of this: I think
  • it handsome. And if you think as I do, you'll give a good sea-cheer for
  • the gentleman that does it.”
  • The cheer followed--that was a matter of course; but it rang out so full
  • and hearty that I confess I could hardly believe these same men were
  • plotting for our blood.
  • “One more cheer for Cap'n Smollett,” cried Long John when the first had
  • subsided.
  • And this also was given with a will.
  • On the top of that the three gentlemen went below, and not long after,
  • word was sent forward that Jim Hawkins was wanted in the cabin.
  • I found them all three seated round the table, a bottle of Spanish wine
  • and some raisins before them, and the doctor smoking away, with his wig
  • on his lap, and that, I knew, was a sign that he was agitated. The stern
  • window was open, for it was a warm night, and you could see the moon
  • shining behind on the ship's wake.
  • “Now, Hawkins,” said the squire, “you have something to say. Speak up.”
  • I did as I was bid, and as short as I could make it, told the whole
  • details of Silver's conversation. Nobody interrupted me till I was done,
  • nor did any one of the three of them make so much as a movement, but
  • they kept their eyes upon my face from first to last.
  • “Jim,” said Dr. Livesey, “take a seat.”
  • And they made me sit down at table beside them, poured me out a glass of
  • wine, filled my hands with raisins, and all three, one after the other,
  • and each with a bow, drank my good health, and their service to me, for
  • my luck and courage.
  • “Now, captain,” said the squire, “you were right, and I was wrong. I own
  • myself an ass, and I await your orders.”
  • “No more an ass than I, sir,” returned the captain. “I never heard of a
  • crew that meant to mutiny but what showed signs before, for any man that
  • had an eye in his head to see the mischief and take steps according. But
  • this crew,” he added, “beats me.”
  • “Captain,” said the doctor, “with your permission, that's Silver. A very
  • remarkable man.”
  • “He'd look remarkably well from a yard-arm, sir,” returned the captain.
  • “But this is talk; this don't lead to anything. I see three or four
  • points, and with Mr. Trelawney's permission, I'll name them.”
  • “You, sir, are the captain. It is for you to speak,” says Mr. Trelawney
  • grandly.
  • “First point,” began Mr. Smollett. “We must go on, because we can't turn
  • back. If I gave the word to go about, they would rise at once. Second
  • point, we have time before us--at least until this treasure's found.
  • Third point, there are faithful hands. Now, sir, it's got to come
  • to blows sooner or later, and what I propose is to take time by the
  • forelock, as the saying is, and come to blows some fine day when they
  • least expect it. We can count, I take it, on your own home servants, Mr.
  • Trelawney?”
  • “As upon myself,” declared the squire.
  • “Three,” reckoned the captain; “ourselves make seven, counting Hawkins
  • here. Now, about the honest hands?”
  • “Most likely Trelawney's own men,” said the doctor; “those he had picked
  • up for himself before he lit on Silver.”
  • “Nay,” replied the squire. “Hands was one of mine.”
  • “I did think I could have trusted Hands,” added the captain.
  • “And to think that they're all Englishmen!” broke out the squire. “Sir,
  • I could find it in my heart to blow the ship up.”
  • “Well, gentlemen,” said the captain, “the best that I can say is not
  • much. We must lay to, if you please, and keep a bright lookout. It's
  • trying on a man, I know. It would be pleasanter to come to blows. But
  • there's no help for it till we know our men. Lay to, and whistle for a
  • wind, that's my view.”
  • “Jim here,” said the doctor, “can help us more than anyone. The men are
  • not shy with him, and Jim is a noticing lad.”
  • “Hawkins, I put prodigious faith in you,” added the squire.
  • I began to feel pretty desperate at this, for I felt altogether
  • helpless; and yet, by an odd train of circumstances, it was indeed
  • through me that safety came. In the meantime, talk as we pleased, there
  • were only seven out of the twenty-six on whom we knew we could rely; and
  • out of these seven one was a boy, so that the grown men on our side were
  • six to their nineteen.
  • PART THREE--My Shore Adventure
  • 13
  • How My Shore Adventure Began
  • THE appearance of the island when I came on deck next morning was
  • altogether changed. Although the breeze had now utterly ceased, we had
  • made a great deal of way during the night and were now lying becalmed
  • about half a mile to the south-east of the low eastern coast.
  • Grey-coloured woods covered a large part of the surface. This even tint
  • was indeed broken up by streaks of yellow sand-break in the lower lands,
  • and by many tall trees of the pine family, out-topping the others--some
  • singly, some in clumps; but the general colouring was uniform and sad.
  • The hills ran up clear above the vegetation in spires of naked rock.
  • All were strangely shaped, and the Spy-glass, which was by three or four
  • hundred feet the tallest on the island, was likewise the strangest in
  • configuration, running up sheer from almost every side and then suddenly
  • cut off at the top like a pedestal to put a statue on.
  • The HISPANIOLA was rolling scuppers under in the ocean swell. The booms
  • were tearing at the blocks, the rudder was banging to and fro, and the
  • whole ship creaking, groaning, and jumping like a manufactory. I had
  • to cling tight to the backstay, and the world turned giddily before my
  • eyes, for though I was a good enough sailor when there was way on, this
  • standing still and being rolled about like a bottle was a thing I never
  • learned to stand without a qualm or so, above all in the morning, on an
  • empty stomach.
  • Perhaps it was this--perhaps it was the look of the island, with its
  • grey, melancholy woods, and wild stone spires, and the surf that we
  • could both see and hear foaming and thundering on the steep beach--at
  • least, although the sun shone bright and hot, and the shore birds were
  • fishing and crying all around us, and you would have thought anyone
  • would have been glad to get to land after being so long at sea, my heart
  • sank, as the saying is, into my boots; and from the first look onward, I
  • hated the very thought of Treasure Island.
  • We had a dreary morning's work before us, for there was no sign of any
  • wind, and the boats had to be got out and manned, and the ship warped
  • three or four miles round the corner of the island and up the narrow
  • passage to the haven behind Skeleton Island. I volunteered for one of
  • the boats, where I had, of course, no business. The heat was sweltering,
  • and the men grumbled fiercely over their work. Anderson was in command
  • of my boat, and instead of keeping the crew in order, he grumbled as
  • loud as the worst.
  • “Well,” he said with an oath, “it's not forever.”
  • I thought this was a very bad sign, for up to that day the men had gone
  • briskly and willingly about their business; but the very sight of the
  • island had relaxed the cords of discipline.
  • All the way in, Long John stood by the steersman and conned the ship.
  • He knew the passage like the palm of his hand, and though the man in the
  • chains got everywhere more water than was down in the chart, John never
  • hesitated once.
  • “There's a strong scour with the ebb,” he said, “and this here passage
  • has been dug out, in a manner of speaking, with a spade.”
  • We brought up just where the anchor was in the chart, about a third of
  • a mile from each shore, the mainland on one side and Skeleton Island on
  • the other. The bottom was clean sand. The plunge of our anchor sent up
  • clouds of birds wheeling and crying over the woods, but in less than a
  • minute they were down again and all was once more silent.
  • The place was entirely land-locked, buried in woods, the trees coming
  • right down to high-water mark, the shores mostly flat, and the hilltops
  • standing round at a distance in a sort of amphitheatre, one here, one
  • there. Two little rivers, or rather two swamps, emptied out into this
  • pond, as you might call it; and the foliage round that part of the shore
  • had a kind of poisonous brightness. From the ship we could see nothing
  • of the house or stockade, for they were quite buried among trees; and if
  • it had not been for the chart on the companion, we might have been the
  • first that had ever anchored there since the island arose out of the
  • seas.
  • There was not a breath of air moving, nor a sound but that of the
  • surf booming half a mile away along the beaches and against the rocks
  • outside. A peculiar stagnant smell hung over the anchorage--a smell of
  • sodden leaves and rotting tree trunks. I observed the doctor sniffing
  • and sniffing, like someone tasting a bad egg.
  • “I don't know about treasure,” he said, “but I'll stake my wig there's
  • fever here.”
  • If the conduct of the men had been alarming in the boat, it became truly
  • threatening when they had come aboard. They lay about the deck growling
  • together in talk. The slightest order was received with a black look and
  • grudgingly and carelessly obeyed. Even the honest hands must have caught
  • the infection, for there was not one man aboard to mend another. Mutiny,
  • it was plain, hung over us like a thunder-cloud.
  • And it was not only we of the cabin party who perceived the danger. Long
  • John was hard at work going from group to group, spending himself in
  • good advice, and as for example no man could have shown a better. He
  • fairly outstripped himself in willingness and civility; he was all
  • smiles to everyone. If an order were given, John would be on his crutch
  • in an instant, with the cheeriest “Aye, aye, sir!” in the world; and
  • when there was nothing else to do, he kept up one song after another, as
  • if to conceal the discontent of the rest.
  • Of all the gloomy features of that gloomy afternoon, this obvious
  • anxiety on the part of Long John appeared the worst.
  • We held a council in the cabin.
  • “Sir,” said the captain, “if I risk another order, the whole ship'll
  • come about our ears by the run. You see, sir, here it is. I get a rough
  • answer, do I not? Well, if I speak back, pikes will be going in two
  • shakes; if I don't, Silver will see there's something under that, and
  • the game's up. Now, we've only one man to rely on.”
  • “And who is that?” asked the squire.
  • “Silver, sir,” returned the captain; “he's as anxious as you and I to
  • smother things up. This is a tiff; he'd soon talk 'em out of it if he
  • had the chance, and what I propose to do is to give him the chance.
  • Let's allow the men an afternoon ashore. If they all go, why we'll fight
  • the ship. If they none of them go, well then, we hold the cabin, and God
  • defend the right. If some go, you mark my words, sir, Silver'll bring
  • 'em aboard again as mild as lambs.”
  • It was so decided; loaded pistols were served out to all the sure men;
  • Hunter, Joyce, and Redruth were taken into our confidence and received
  • the news with less surprise and a better spirit than we had looked for,
  • and then the captain went on deck and addressed the crew.
  • “My lads,” said he, “we've had a hot day and are all tired and out of
  • sorts. A turn ashore'll hurt nobody--the boats are still in the water;
  • you can take the gigs, and as many as please may go ashore for the
  • afternoon. I'll fire a gun half an hour before sundown.”
  • I believe the silly fellows must have thought they would break their
  • shins over treasure as soon as they were landed, for they all came out
  • of their sulks in a moment and gave a cheer that started the echo in a
  • faraway hill and sent the birds once more flying and squalling round the
  • anchorage.
  • The captain was too bright to be in the way. He whipped out of sight
  • in a moment, leaving Silver to arrange the party, and I fancy it was as
  • well he did so. Had he been on deck, he could no longer so much as
  • have pretended not to understand the situation. It was as plain as day.
  • Silver was the captain, and a mighty rebellious crew he had of it. The
  • honest hands--and I was soon to see it proved that there were such on
  • board--must have been very stupid fellows. Or rather, I suppose the
  • truth was this, that all hands were disaffected by the example of the
  • ringleaders--only some more, some less; and a few, being good fellows in
  • the main, could neither be led nor driven any further. It is one thing
  • to be idle and skulk and quite another to take a ship and murder a
  • number of innocent men.
  • At last, however, the party was made up. Six fellows were to stay on
  • board, and the remaining thirteen, including Silver, began to embark.
  • Then it was that there came into my head the first of the mad notions
  • that contributed so much to save our lives. If six men were left by
  • Silver, it was plain our party could not take and fight the ship; and
  • since only six were left, it was equally plain that the cabin party
  • had no present need of my assistance. It occurred to me at once to go
  • ashore. In a jiffy I had slipped over the side and curled up in the
  • fore-sheets of the nearest boat, and almost at the same moment she
  • shoved off.
  • No one took notice of me, only the bow oar saying, “Is that you, Jim?
  • Keep your head down.” But Silver, from the other boat, looked sharply
  • over and called out to know if that were me; and from that moment I
  • began to regret what I had done.
  • The crews raced for the beach, but the boat I was in, having some start
  • and being at once the lighter and the better manned, shot far ahead of
  • her consort, and the bow had struck among the shore-side trees and I
  • had caught a branch and swung myself out and plunged into the nearest
  • thicket while Silver and the rest were still a hundred yards behind.
  • “Jim, Jim!” I heard him shouting.
  • But you may suppose I paid no heed; jumping, ducking, and breaking
  • through, I ran straight before my nose till I could run no longer.
  • 14
  • The First Blow
  • I WAS so pleased at having given the slip to Long John that I began to
  • enjoy myself and look around me with some interest on the strange land
  • that I was in.
  • I had crossed a marshy tract full of willows, bulrushes, and odd,
  • outlandish, swampy trees; and I had now come out upon the skirts of an
  • open piece of undulating, sandy country, about a mile long, dotted with
  • a few pines and a great number of contorted trees, not unlike the oak
  • in growth, but pale in the foliage, like willows. On the far side of
  • the open stood one of the hills, with two quaint, craggy peaks shining
  • vividly in the sun.
  • I now felt for the first time the joy of exploration. The isle was
  • uninhabited; my shipmates I had left behind, and nothing lived in front
  • of me but dumb brutes and fowls. I turned hither and thither among the
  • trees. Here and there were flowering plants, unknown to me; here and
  • there I saw snakes, and one raised his head from a ledge of rock and
  • hissed at me with a noise not unlike the spinning of a top. Little did
  • I suppose that he was a deadly enemy and that the noise was the famous
  • rattle.
  • Then I came to a long thicket of these oaklike trees--live, or
  • evergreen, oaks, I heard afterwards they should be called--which grew
  • low along the sand like brambles, the boughs curiously twisted, the
  • foliage compact, like thatch. The thicket stretched down from the top of
  • one of the sandy knolls, spreading and growing taller as it went, until
  • it reached the margin of the broad, reedy fen, through which the nearest
  • of the little rivers soaked its way into the anchorage. The marsh was
  • steaming in the strong sun, and the outline of the Spy-glass trembled
  • through the haze.
  • All at once there began to go a sort of bustle among the bulrushes;
  • a wild duck flew up with a quack, another followed, and soon over the
  • whole surface of the marsh a great cloud of birds hung screaming and
  • circling in the air. I judged at once that some of my shipmates must be
  • drawing near along the borders of the fen. Nor was I deceived, for soon
  • I heard the very distant and low tones of a human voice, which, as I
  • continued to give ear, grew steadily louder and nearer.
  • This put me in a great fear, and I crawled under cover of the nearest
  • live-oak and squatted there, hearkening, as silent as a mouse.
  • Another voice answered, and then the first voice, which I now recognized
  • to be Silver's, once more took up the story and ran on for a long while
  • in a stream, only now and again interrupted by the other. By the sound
  • they must have been talking earnestly, and almost fiercely; but no
  • distinct word came to my hearing.
  • At last the speakers seemed to have paused and perhaps to have sat down,
  • for not only did they cease to draw any nearer, but the birds themselves
  • began to grow more quiet and to settle again to their places in the
  • swamp.
  • And now I began to feel that I was neglecting my business, that since
  • I had been so foolhardy as to come ashore with these desperadoes, the
  • least I could do was to overhear them at their councils, and that my
  • plain and obvious duty was to draw as close as I could manage, under the
  • favourable ambush of the crouching trees.
  • I could tell the direction of the speakers pretty exactly, not only by
  • the sound of their voices but by the behaviour of the few birds that
  • still hung in alarm above the heads of the intruders.
  • Crawling on all fours, I made steadily but slowly towards them, till at
  • last, raising my head to an aperture among the leaves, I could see clear
  • down into a little green dell beside the marsh, and closely set about
  • with trees, where Long John Silver and another of the crew stood face to
  • face in conversation.
  • The sun beat full upon them. Silver had thrown his hat beside him on the
  • ground, and his great, smooth, blond face, all shining with heat, was
  • lifted to the other man's in a kind of appeal.
  • “Mate,” he was saying, “it's because I thinks gold dust of you--gold
  • dust, and you may lay to that! If I hadn't took to you like pitch, do
  • you think I'd have been here a-warning of you? All's up--you can't make
  • nor mend; it's to save your neck that I'm a-speaking, and if one of the
  • wild uns knew it, where'd I be, Tom--now, tell me, where'd I be?”
  • “Silver,” said the other man--and I observed he was not only red in the
  • face, but spoke as hoarse as a crow, and his voice shook too, like a
  • taut rope--“Silver,” says he, “you're old, and you're honest, or has the
  • name for it; and you've money too, which lots of poor sailors hasn't;
  • and you're brave, or I'm mistook. And will you tell me you'll let
  • yourself be led away with that kind of a mess of swabs? Not you! As sure
  • as God sees me, I'd sooner lose my hand. If I turn agin my dooty--”
  • And then all of a sudden he was interrupted by a noise. I had found
  • one of the honest hands--well, here, at that same moment, came news of
  • another. Far away out in the marsh there arose, all of a sudden, a sound
  • like the cry of anger, then another on the back of it; and then one
  • horrid, long-drawn scream. The rocks of the Spy-glass re-echoed it a
  • score of times; the whole troop of marsh-birds rose again, darkening
  • heaven, with a simultaneous whirr; and long after that death yell was
  • still ringing in my brain, silence had re-established its empire, and
  • only the rustle of the redescending birds and the boom of the distant
  • surges disturbed the languor of the afternoon.
  • Tom had leaped at the sound, like a horse at the spur, but Silver had
  • not winked an eye. He stood where he was, resting lightly on his crutch,
  • watching his companion like a snake about to spring.
  • “John!” said the sailor, stretching out his hand.
  • “Hands off!” cried Silver, leaping back a yard, as it seemed to me, with
  • the speed and security of a trained gymnast.
  • “Hands off, if you like, John Silver,” said the other. “It's a black
  • conscience that can make you feared of me. But in heaven's name, tell
  • me, what was that?”
  • “That?” returned Silver, smiling away, but warier than ever, his eye
  • a mere pin-point in his big face, but gleaming like a crumb of glass.
  • “That? Oh, I reckon that'll be Alan.”
  • And at this point Tom flashed out like a hero.
  • “Alan!” he cried. “Then rest his soul for a true seaman! And as for you,
  • John Silver, long you've been a mate of mine, but you're mate of mine
  • no more. If I die like a dog, I'll die in my dooty. You've killed Alan,
  • have you? Kill me too, if you can. But I defies you.”
  • And with that, this brave fellow turned his back directly on the cook
  • and set off walking for the beach. But he was not destined to go far.
  • With a cry John seized the branch of a tree, whipped the crutch out of
  • his armpit, and sent that uncouth missile hurtling through the air.
  • It struck poor Tom, point foremost, and with stunning violence, right
  • between the shoulders in the middle of his back. His hands flew up, he
  • gave a sort of gasp, and fell.
  • Whether he were injured much or little, none could ever tell. Like
  • enough, to judge from the sound, his back was broken on the spot. But he
  • had no time given him to recover. Silver, agile as a monkey even without
  • leg or crutch, was on the top of him next moment and had twice buried
  • his knife up to the hilt in that defenceless body. From my place of
  • ambush, I could hear him pant aloud as he struck the blows.
  • I do not know what it rightly is to faint, but I do know that for the
  • next little while the whole world swam away from before me in a whirling
  • mist; Silver and the birds, and the tall Spy-glass hilltop, going
  • round and round and topsy-turvy before my eyes, and all manner of bells
  • ringing and distant voices shouting in my ear.
  • When I came again to myself the monster had pulled himself together,
  • his crutch under his arm, his hat upon his head. Just before him Tom
  • lay motionless upon the sward; but the murderer minded him not a whit,
  • cleansing his blood-stained knife the while upon a wisp of grass.
  • Everything else was unchanged, the sun still shining mercilessly on the
  • steaming marsh and the tall pinnacle of the mountain, and I could scarce
  • persuade myself that murder had been actually done and a human life
  • cruelly cut short a moment since before my eyes.
  • But now John put his hand into his pocket, brought out a whistle, and
  • blew upon it several modulated blasts that rang far across the heated
  • air. I could not tell, of course, the meaning of the signal, but
  • it instantly awoke my fears. More men would be coming. I might be
  • discovered. They had already slain two of the honest people; after Tom
  • and Alan, might not I come next?
  • Instantly I began to extricate myself and crawl back again, with what
  • speed and silence I could manage, to the more open portion of the
  • wood. As I did so, I could hear hails coming and going between the old
  • buccaneer and his comrades, and this sound of danger lent me wings. As
  • soon as I was clear of the thicket, I ran as I never ran before, scarce
  • minding the direction of my flight, so long as it led me from the
  • murderers; and as I ran, fear grew and grew upon me until it turned into
  • a kind of frenzy.
  • Indeed, could anyone be more entirely lost than I? When the gun fired,
  • how should I dare to go down to the boats among those fiends, still
  • smoking from their crime? Would not the first of them who saw me wring
  • my neck like a snipe's? Would not my absence itself be an evidence to
  • them of my alarm, and therefore of my fatal knowledge? It was all over,
  • I thought. Good-bye to the HISPANIOLA; good-bye to the squire, the
  • doctor, and the captain! There was nothing left for me but death by
  • starvation or death by the hands of the mutineers.
  • All this while, as I say, I was still running, and without taking any
  • notice, I had drawn near to the foot of the little hill with the two
  • peaks and had got into a part of the island where the live-oaks grew
  • more widely apart and seemed more like forest trees in their bearing and
  • dimensions. Mingled with these were a few scattered pines, some fifty,
  • some nearer seventy, feet high. The air too smelt more freshly than down
  • beside the marsh.
  • And here a fresh alarm brought me to a standstill with a thumping heart.
  • 15
  • The Man of the Island
  • FROM the side of the hill, which was here steep and stony, a spout of
  • gravel was dislodged and fell rattling and bounding through the trees.
  • My eyes turned instinctively in that direction, and I saw a figure leap
  • with great rapidity behind the trunk of a pine. What it was, whether
  • bear or man or monkey, I could in no wise tell. It seemed dark and
  • shaggy; more I knew not. But the terror of this new apparition brought
  • me to a stand.
  • I was now, it seemed, cut off upon both sides; behind me the murderers,
  • before me this lurking nondescript. And immediately I began to prefer
  • the dangers that I knew to those I knew not. Silver himself appeared
  • less terrible in contrast with this creature of the woods, and I turned
  • on my heel, and looking sharply behind me over my shoulder, began to
  • retrace my steps in the direction of the boats.
  • Instantly the figure reappeared, and making a wide circuit, began to
  • head me off. I was tired, at any rate; but had I been as fresh as when I
  • rose, I could see it was in vain for me to contend in speed with such an
  • adversary. From trunk to trunk the creature flitted like a deer, running
  • manlike on two legs, but unlike any man that I had ever seen, stooping
  • almost double as it ran. Yet a man it was, I could no longer be in doubt
  • about that.
  • I began to recall what I had heard of cannibals. I was within an ace of
  • calling for help. But the mere fact that he was a man, however wild,
  • had somewhat reassured me, and my fear of Silver began to revive in
  • proportion. I stood still, therefore, and cast about for some method of
  • escape; and as I was so thinking, the recollection of my pistol flashed
  • into my mind. As soon as I remembered I was not defenceless, courage
  • glowed again in my heart and I set my face resolutely for this man of
  • the island and walked briskly towards him.
  • He was concealed by this time behind another tree trunk; but he must
  • have been watching me closely, for as soon as I began to move in his
  • direction he reappeared and took a step to meet me. Then he hesitated,
  • drew back, came forward again, and at last, to my wonder and
  • confusion, threw himself on his knees and held out his clasped hands in
  • supplication.
  • At that I once more stopped.
  • “Who are you?” I asked.
  • “Ben Gunn,” he answered, and his voice sounded hoarse and awkward,
  • like a rusty lock. “I'm poor Ben Gunn, I am; and I haven't spoke with a
  • Christian these three years.”
  • I could now see that he was a white man like myself and that his
  • features were even pleasing. His skin, wherever it was exposed, was
  • burnt by the sun; even his lips were black, and his fair eyes looked
  • quite startling in so dark a face. Of all the beggar-men that I had seen
  • or fancied, he was the chief for raggedness. He was clothed with tatters
  • of old ship's canvas and old sea-cloth, and this extraordinary patchwork
  • was all held together by a system of the most various and incongruous
  • fastenings, brass buttons, bits of stick, and loops of tarry gaskin.
  • About his waist he wore an old brass-buckled leather belt, which was the
  • one thing solid in his whole accoutrement.
  • “Three years!” I cried. “Were you shipwrecked?”
  • “Nay, mate,” said he; “marooned.”
  • I had heard the word, and I knew it stood for a horrible kind of
  • punishment common enough among the buccaneers, in which the offender
  • is put ashore with a little powder and shot and left behind on some
  • desolate and distant island.
  • “Marooned three years agone,” he continued, “and lived on goats since
  • then, and berries, and oysters. Wherever a man is, says I, a man can
  • do for himself. But, mate, my heart is sore for Christian diet. You
  • mightn't happen to have a piece of cheese about you, now? No? Well,
  • many's the long night I've dreamed of cheese--toasted, mostly--and woke
  • up again, and here I were.”
  • “If ever I can get aboard again,” said I, “you shall have cheese by the
  • stone.”
  • All this time he had been feeling the stuff of my jacket, smoothing
  • my hands, looking at my boots, and generally, in the intervals of
  • his speech, showing a childish pleasure in the presence of a fellow
  • creature. But at my last words he perked up into a kind of startled
  • slyness.
  • “If ever you can get aboard again, says you?” he repeated. “Why, now,
  • who's to hinder you?”
  • “Not you, I know,” was my reply.
  • “And right you was,” he cried. “Now you--what do you call yourself,
  • mate?”
  • “Jim,” I told him.
  • “Jim, Jim,” says he, quite pleased apparently. “Well, now, Jim, I've
  • lived that rough as you'd be ashamed to hear of. Now, for instance, you
  • wouldn't think I had had a pious mother--to look at me?” he asked.
  • “Why, no, not in particular,” I answered.
  • “Ah, well,” said he, “but I had--remarkable pious. And I was a civil,
  • pious boy, and could rattle off my catechism that fast, as you couldn't
  • tell one word from another. And here's what it come to, Jim, and it
  • begun with chuck-farthen on the blessed grave-stones! That's what it
  • begun with, but it went further'n that; and so my mother told me, and
  • predicked the whole, she did, the pious woman! But it were Providence
  • that put me here. I've thought it all out in this here lonely island,
  • and I'm back on piety. You don't catch me tasting rum so much, but just
  • a thimbleful for luck, of course, the first chance I have. I'm bound
  • I'll be good, and I see the way to. And, Jim”--looking all round him and
  • lowering his voice to a whisper--“I'm rich.”
  • I now felt sure that the poor fellow had gone crazy in his solitude, and
  • I suppose I must have shown the feeling in my face, for he repeated the
  • statement hotly: “Rich! Rich! I says. And I'll tell you what: I'll make
  • a man of you, Jim. Ah, Jim, you'll bless your stars, you will, you was
  • the first that found me!”
  • And at this there came suddenly a lowering shadow over his face, and he
  • tightened his grasp upon my hand and raised a forefinger threateningly
  • before my eyes.
  • “Now, Jim, you tell me true: that ain't Flint's ship?” he asked.
  • At this I had a happy inspiration. I began to believe that I had found
  • an ally, and I answered him at once.
  • “It's not Flint's ship, and Flint is dead; but I'll tell you true, as
  • you ask me--there are some of Flint's hands aboard; worse luck for the
  • rest of us.”
  • “Not a man--with one--leg?” he gasped.
  • “Silver?” I asked.
  • “Ah, Silver!” says he. “That were his name.”
  • “He's the cook, and the ringleader too.”
  • He was still holding me by the wrist, and at that he give it quite a
  • wring.
  • “If you was sent by Long John,” he said, “I'm as good as pork, and I
  • know it. But where was you, do you suppose?”
  • I had made my mind up in a moment, and by way of answer told him
  • the whole story of our voyage and the predicament in which we found
  • ourselves. He heard me with the keenest interest, and when I had done he
  • patted me on the head.
  • “You're a good lad, Jim,” he said; “and you're all in a clove hitch,
  • ain't you? Well, you just put your trust in Ben Gunn--Ben Gunn's the man
  • to do it. Would you think it likely, now, that your squire would prove
  • a liberal-minded one in case of help--him being in a clove hitch, as you
  • remark?”
  • I told him the squire was the most liberal of men.
  • “Aye, but you see,” returned Ben Gunn, “I didn't mean giving me a gate
  • to keep, and a suit of livery clothes, and such; that's not my mark,
  • Jim. What I mean is, would he be likely to come down to the toon of, say
  • one thousand pounds out of money that's as good as a man's own already?”
  • “I am sure he would,” said I. “As it was, all hands were to share.”
  • “AND a passage home?” he added with a look of great shrewdness.
  • “Why,” I cried, “the squire's a gentleman. And besides, if we got rid of
  • the others, we should want you to help work the vessel home.”
  • “Ah,” said he, “so you would.” And he seemed very much relieved.
  • “Now, I'll tell you what,” he went on. “So much I'll tell you, and no
  • more. I were in Flint's ship when he buried the treasure; he and
  • six along--six strong seamen. They was ashore nigh on a week, and us
  • standing off and on in the old WALRUS. One fine day up went the signal,
  • and here come Flint by himself in a little boat, and his head done up in
  • a blue scarf. The sun was getting up, and mortal white he looked about
  • the cutwater. But, there he was, you mind, and the six all dead--dead
  • and buried. How he done it, not a man aboard us could make out. It was
  • battle, murder, and sudden death, leastways--him against six. Billy
  • Bones was the mate; Long John, he was quartermaster; and they asked him
  • where the treasure was. 'Ah,' says he, 'you can go ashore, if you like,
  • and stay,' he says; 'but as for the ship, she'll beat up for more, by
  • thunder!' That's what he said.
  • “Well, I was in another ship three years back, and we sighted this
  • island. 'Boys,' said I, 'here's Flint's treasure; let's land and find
  • it.' The cap'n was displeased at that, but my messmates were all of a
  • mind and landed. Twelve days they looked for it, and every day they had
  • the worse word for me, until one fine morning all hands went aboard. 'As
  • for you, Benjamin Gunn,' says they, 'here's a musket,' they says, 'and
  • a spade, and pick-axe. You can stay here and find Flint's money for
  • yourself,' they says.
  • “Well, Jim, three years have I been here, and not a bite of Christian
  • diet from that day to this. But now, you look here; look at me. Do I
  • look like a man before the mast? No, says you. Nor I weren't, neither, I
  • says.”
  • And with that he winked and pinched me hard.
  • “Just you mention them words to your squire, Jim,” he went on. “Nor he
  • weren't, neither--that's the words. Three years he were the man of this
  • island, light and dark, fair and rain; and sometimes he would maybe
  • think upon a prayer (says you), and sometimes he would maybe think of
  • his old mother, so be as she's alive (you'll say); but the most part
  • of Gunn's time (this is what you'll say)--the most part of his time was
  • took up with another matter. And then you'll give him a nip, like I do.”
  • And he pinched me again in the most confidential manner.
  • “Then,” he continued, “then you'll up, and you'll say this: Gunn is a
  • good man (you'll say), and he puts a precious sight more confidence--a
  • precious sight, mind that--in a gen'leman born than in these gen'leman
  • of fortune, having been one hisself.”
  • “Well,” I said, “I don't understand one word that you've been saying.
  • But that's neither here nor there; for how am I to get on board?”
  • “Ah,” said he, “that's the hitch, for sure. Well, there's my boat, that
  • I made with my two hands. I keep her under the white rock. If the worst
  • come to the worst, we might try that after dark. Hi!” he broke out.
  • “What's that?”
  • For just then, although the sun had still an hour or two to run, all the
  • echoes of the island awoke and bellowed to the thunder of a cannon.
  • “They have begun to fight!” I cried. “Follow me.”
  • And I began to run towards the anchorage, my terrors all forgotten,
  • while close at my side the marooned man in his goatskins trotted easily
  • and lightly.
  • “Left, left,” says he; “keep to your left hand, mate Jim! Under the
  • trees with you! Theer's where I killed my first goat. They don't come
  • down here now; they're all mastheaded on them mountings for the fear
  • of Benjamin Gunn. Ah! And there's the cetemery”--cemetery, he must have
  • meant. “You see the mounds? I come here and prayed, nows and thens, when
  • I thought maybe a Sunday would be about doo. It weren't quite a chapel,
  • but it seemed more solemn like; and then, says you, Ben Gunn was
  • short-handed--no chapling, nor so much as a Bible and a flag, you says.”
  • So he kept talking as I ran, neither expecting nor receiving any answer.
  • The cannon-shot was followed after a considerable interval by a volley
  • of small arms.
  • Another pause, and then, not a quarter of a mile in front of me, I
  • beheld the Union Jack flutter in the air above a wood.
  • PART FOUR--The Stockade
  • 16
  • Narrative Continued by the Doctor: How the Ship Was Abandoned
  • IT was about half past one--three bells in the sea phrase--that the two
  • boats went ashore from the HISPANIOLA. The captain, the squire, and I
  • were talking matters over in the cabin. Had there been a breath of wind,
  • we should have fallen on the six mutineers who were left aboard with
  • us, slipped our cable, and away to sea. But the wind was wanting; and
  • to complete our helplessness, down came Hunter with the news that Jim
  • Hawkins had slipped into a boat and was gone ashore with the rest.
  • It never occurred to us to doubt Jim Hawkins, but we were alarmed for
  • his safety. With the men in the temper they were in, it seemed an even
  • chance if we should see the lad again. We ran on deck. The pitch was
  • bubbling in the seams; the nasty stench of the place turned me sick;
  • if ever a man smelt fever and dysentery, it was in that abominable
  • anchorage. The six scoundrels were sitting grumbling under a sail in the
  • forecastle; ashore we could see the gigs made fast and a man sitting
  • in each, hard by where the river runs in. One of them was whistling
  • “Lillibullero.”
  • Waiting was a strain, and it was decided that Hunter and I should go
  • ashore with the jolly-boat in quest of information.
  • The gigs had leaned to their right, but Hunter and I pulled straight in,
  • in the direction of the stockade upon the chart. The two who were
  • left guarding their boats seemed in a bustle at our appearance;
  • “Lillibullero” stopped off, and I could see the pair discussing what
  • they ought to do. Had they gone and told Silver, all might have turned
  • out differently; but they had their orders, I suppose, and decided to
  • sit quietly where they were and hark back again to “Lillibullero.”
  • There was a slight bend in the coast, and I steered so as to put it
  • between us; even before we landed we had thus lost sight of the gigs.
  • I jumped out and came as near running as I durst, with a big silk
  • handkerchief under my hat for coolness' sake and a brace of pistols
  • ready primed for safety.
  • I had not gone a hundred yards when I reached the stockade.
  • This was how it was: a spring of clear water rose almost at the top of a
  • knoll. Well, on the knoll, and enclosing the spring, they had clapped a
  • stout loghouse fit to hold two score of people on a pinch and loopholed
  • for musketry on either side. All round this they had cleared a wide
  • space, and then the thing was completed by a paling six feet high,
  • without door or opening, too strong to pull down without time and labour
  • and too open to shelter the besiegers. The people in the log-house had
  • them in every way; they stood quiet in shelter and shot the others like
  • partridges. All they wanted was a good watch and food; for, short of a
  • complete surprise, they might have held the place against a regiment.
  • What particularly took my fancy was the spring. For though we had a good
  • enough place of it in the cabin of the HISPANIOLA, with plenty of arms
  • and ammunition, and things to eat, and excellent wines, there had been
  • one thing overlooked--we had no water. I was thinking this over when
  • there came ringing over the island the cry of a man at the point of
  • death. I was not new to violent death--I have served his Royal Highness
  • the Duke of Cumberland, and got a wound myself at Fontenoy--but I know
  • my pulse went dot and carry one. “Jim Hawkins is gone,” was my first
  • thought.
  • It is something to have been an old soldier, but more still to have been
  • a doctor. There is no time to dilly-dally in our work. And so now I made
  • up my mind instantly, and with no time lost returned to the shore and
  • jumped on board the jolly-boat.
  • By good fortune Hunter pulled a good oar. We made the water fly, and the
  • boat was soon alongside and I aboard the schooner.
  • I found them all shaken, as was natural. The squire was sitting down, as
  • white as a sheet, thinking of the harm he had led us to, the good soul!
  • And one of the six forecastle hands was little better.
  • “There's a man,” says Captain Smollett, nodding towards him, “new to
  • this work. He came nigh-hand fainting, doctor, when he heard the cry.
  • Another touch of the rudder and that man would join us.”
  • I told my plan to the captain, and between us we settled on the details
  • of its accomplishment.
  • We put old Redruth in the gallery between the cabin and the forecastle,
  • with three or four loaded muskets and a mattress for protection. Hunter
  • brought the boat round under the stern-port, and Joyce and I set to work
  • loading her with powder tins, muskets, bags of biscuits, kegs of pork, a
  • cask of cognac, and my invaluable medicine chest.
  • In the meantime, the squire and the captain stayed on deck, and the
  • latter hailed the coxswain, who was the principal man aboard.
  • “Mr. Hands,” he said, “here are two of us with a brace of pistols each.
  • If any one of you six make a signal of any description, that man's
  • dead.”
  • They were a good deal taken aback, and after a little consultation one
  • and all tumbled down the fore companion, thinking no doubt to take us
  • on the rear. But when they saw Redruth waiting for them in the sparred
  • galley, they went about ship at once, and a head popped out again on
  • deck.
  • “Down, dog!” cries the captain.
  • And the head popped back again; and we heard no more, for the time, of
  • these six very faint-hearted seamen.
  • By this time, tumbling things in as they came, we had the jolly-boat
  • loaded as much as we dared. Joyce and I got out through the stern-port,
  • and we made for shore again as fast as oars could take us.
  • This second trip fairly aroused the watchers along shore. “Lillibullero”
  • was dropped again; and just before we lost sight of them behind the
  • little point, one of them whipped ashore and disappeared. I had half a
  • mind to change my plan and destroy their boats, but I feared that Silver
  • and the others might be close at hand, and all might very well be lost
  • by trying for too much.
  • We had soon touched land in the same place as before and set to
  • provision the block house. All three made the first journey, heavily
  • laden, and tossed our stores over the palisade. Then, leaving Joyce to
  • guard them--one man, to be sure, but with half a dozen muskets--Hunter
  • and I returned to the jolly-boat and loaded ourselves once more. So
  • we proceeded without pausing to take breath, till the whole cargo was
  • bestowed, when the two servants took up their position in the block
  • house, and I, with all my power, sculled back to the HISPANIOLA.
  • That we should have risked a second boat load seems more daring than it
  • really was. They had the advantage of numbers, of course, but we had the
  • advantage of arms. Not one of the men ashore had a musket, and before
  • they could get within range for pistol shooting, we flattered ourselves
  • we should be able to give a good account of a half-dozen at least.
  • The squire was waiting for me at the stern window, all his faintness
  • gone from him. He caught the painter and made it fast, and we fell to
  • loading the boat for our very lives. Pork, powder, and biscuit was the
  • cargo, with only a musket and a cutlass apiece for the squire and me
  • and Redruth and the captain. The rest of the arms and powder we dropped
  • overboard in two fathoms and a half of water, so that we could see
  • the bright steel shining far below us in the sun, on the clean, sandy
  • bottom.
  • By this time the tide was beginning to ebb, and the ship was swinging
  • round to her anchor. Voices were heard faintly halloaing in the
  • direction of the two gigs; and though this reassured us for Joyce and
  • Hunter, who were well to the eastward, it warned our party to be off.
  • Redruth retreated from his place in the gallery and dropped into the
  • boat, which we then brought round to the ship's counter, to be handier
  • for Captain Smollett.
  • “Now, men,” said he, “do you hear me?”
  • There was no answer from the forecastle.
  • “It's to you, Abraham Gray--it's to you I am speaking.”
  • Still no reply.
  • “Gray,” resumed Mr. Smollett, a little louder, “I am leaving this ship,
  • and I order you to follow your captain. I know you are a good man at
  • bottom, and I dare say not one of the lot of you's as bad as he makes
  • out. I have my watch here in my hand; I give you thirty seconds to join
  • me in.”
  • There was a pause.
  • “Come, my fine fellow,” continued the captain; “don't hang so long in
  • stays. I'm risking my life and the lives of these good gentlemen every
  • second.”
  • There was a sudden scuffle, a sound of blows, and out burst Abraham
  • Gray with a knife cut on the side of the cheek, and came running to the
  • captain like a dog to the whistle.
  • “I'm with you, sir,” said he.
  • And the next moment he and the captain had dropped aboard of us, and we
  • had shoved off and given way.
  • We were clear out of the ship, but not yet ashore in our stockade.
  • 17
  • Narrative Continued by the Doctor: The Jolly-boat's Last Trip
  • THIS fifth trip was quite different from any of the others. In the
  • first place, the little gallipot of a boat that we were in was gravely
  • overloaded. Five grown men, and three of them--Trelawney, Redruth, and
  • the captain--over six feet high, was already more than she was meant
  • to carry. Add to that the powder, pork, and bread-bags. The gunwale was
  • lipping astern. Several times we shipped a little water, and my breeches
  • and the tails of my coat were all soaking wet before we had gone a
  • hundred yards.
  • The captain made us trim the boat, and we got her to lie a little more
  • evenly. All the same, we were afraid to breathe.
  • In the second place, the ebb was now making--a strong rippling current
  • running westward through the basin, and then south'ard and seaward down
  • the straits by which we had entered in the morning. Even the ripples
  • were a danger to our overloaded craft, but the worst of it was that we
  • were swept out of our true course and away from our proper landing-place
  • behind the point. If we let the current have its way we should come
  • ashore beside the gigs, where the pirates might appear at any moment.
  • “I cannot keep her head for the stockade, sir,” said I to the captain.
  • I was steering, while he and Redruth, two fresh men, were at the oars.
  • “The tide keeps washing her down. Could you pull a little stronger?”
  • “Not without swamping the boat,” said he. “You must bear up, sir, if you
  • please--bear up until you see you're gaining.”
  • I tried and found by experiment that the tide kept sweeping us westward
  • until I had laid her head due east, or just about right angles to the
  • way we ought to go.
  • “We'll never get ashore at this rate,” said I.
  • “If it's the only course that we can lie, sir, we must even lie it,”
  • returned the captain. “We must keep upstream. You see, sir,” he went on,
  • “if once we dropped to leeward of the landing-place, it's hard to say
  • where we should get ashore, besides the chance of being boarded by the
  • gigs; whereas, the way we go the current must slacken, and then we can
  • dodge back along the shore.”
  • “The current's less a'ready, sir,” said the man Gray, who was sitting in
  • the fore-sheets; “you can ease her off a bit.”
  • “Thank you, my man,” said I, quite as if nothing had happened, for we
  • had all quietly made up our minds to treat him like one of ourselves.
  • Suddenly the captain spoke up again, and I thought his voice was a
  • little changed.
  • “The gun!” said he.
  • “I have thought of that,” said I, for I made sure he was thinking of a
  • bombardment of the fort. “They could never get the gun ashore, and if
  • they did, they could never haul it through the woods.”
  • “Look astern, doctor,” replied the captain.
  • We had entirely forgotten the long nine; and there, to our horror, were
  • the five rogues busy about her, getting off her jacket, as they called
  • the stout tarpaulin cover under which she sailed. Not only that, but
  • it flashed into my mind at the same moment that the round-shot and the
  • powder for the gun had been left behind, and a stroke with an axe would
  • put it all into the possession of the evil ones abroad.
  • “Israel was Flint's gunner,” said Gray hoarsely.
  • At any risk, we put the boat's head direct for the landing-place. By
  • this time we had got so far out of the run of the current that we kept
  • steerage way even at our necessarily gentle rate of rowing, and I could
  • keep her steady for the goal. But the worst of it was that with the
  • course I now held we turned our broadside instead of our stern to the
  • HISPANIOLA and offered a target like a barn door.
  • I could hear as well as see that brandy-faced rascal Israel Hands
  • plumping down a round-shot on the deck.
  • “Who's the best shot?” asked the captain.
  • “Mr. Trelawney, out and away,” said I.
  • “Mr. Trelawney, will you please pick me off one of these men, sir?
  • Hands, if possible,” said the captain.
  • Trelawney was as cool as steel. He looked to the priming of his gun.
  • “Now,” cried the captain, “easy with that gun, sir, or you'll swamp the
  • boat. All hands stand by to trim her when he aims.”
  • The squire raised his gun, the rowing ceased, and we leaned over to the
  • other side to keep the balance, and all was so nicely contrived that we
  • did not ship a drop.
  • They had the gun, by this time, slewed round upon the swivel, and Hands,
  • who was at the muzzle with the rammer, was in consequence the most
  • exposed. However, we had no luck, for just as Trelawney fired, down he
  • stooped, the ball whistled over him, and it was one of the other four
  • who fell.
  • The cry he gave was echoed not only by his companions on board but by a
  • great number of voices from the shore, and looking in that direction
  • I saw the other pirates trooping out from among the trees and tumbling
  • into their places in the boats.
  • “Here come the gigs, sir,” said I.
  • “Give way, then,” cried the captain. “We mustn't mind if we swamp her
  • now. If we can't get ashore, all's up.”
  • “Only one of the gigs is being manned, sir,” I added; “the crew of the
  • other most likely going round by shore to cut us off.”
  • “They'll have a hot run, sir,” returned the captain. “Jack ashore, you
  • know. It's not them I mind; it's the round-shot. Carpet bowls! My lady's
  • maid couldn't miss. Tell us, squire, when you see the match, and we'll
  • hold water.”
  • In the meanwhile we had been making headway at a good pace for a boat so
  • overloaded, and we had shipped but little water in the process. We were
  • now close in; thirty or forty strokes and we should beach her, for the
  • ebb had already disclosed a narrow belt of sand below the clustering
  • trees. The gig was no longer to be feared; the little point had already
  • concealed it from our eyes. The ebb-tide, which had so cruelly delayed
  • us, was now making reparation and delaying our assailants. The one
  • source of danger was the gun.
  • “If I durst,” said the captain, “I'd stop and pick off another man.”
  • But it was plain that they meant nothing should delay their shot. They
  • had never so much as looked at their fallen comrade, though he was not
  • dead, and I could see him trying to crawl away.
  • “Ready!” cried the squire.
  • “Hold!” cried the captain, quick as an echo.
  • And he and Redruth backed with a great heave that sent her stern bodily
  • under water. The report fell in at the same instant of time. This was
  • the first that Jim heard, the sound of the squire's shot not having
  • reached him. Where the ball passed, not one of us precisely knew, but I
  • fancy it must have been over our heads and that the wind of it may have
  • contributed to our disaster.
  • At any rate, the boat sank by the stern, quite gently, in three feet of
  • water, leaving the captain and myself, facing each other, on our feet.
  • The other three took complete headers, and came up again drenched and
  • bubbling.
  • So far there was no great harm. No lives were lost, and we could wade
  • ashore in safety. But there were all our stores at the bottom, and to
  • make things worse, only two guns out of five remained in a state for
  • service. Mine I had snatched from my knees and held over my head, by
  • a sort of instinct. As for the captain, he had carried his over his
  • shoulder by a bandoleer, and like a wise man, lock uppermost. The other
  • three had gone down with the boat.
  • To add to our concern, we heard voices already drawing near us in the
  • woods along shore, and we had not only the danger of being cut off from
  • the stockade in our half-crippled state but the fear before us whether,
  • if Hunter and Joyce were attacked by half a dozen, they would have the
  • sense and conduct to stand firm. Hunter was steady, that we knew; Joyce
  • was a doubtful case--a pleasant, polite man for a valet and to brush
  • one's clothes, but not entirely fitted for a man of war.
  • With all this in our minds, we waded ashore as fast as we could, leaving
  • behind us the poor jolly-boat and a good half of all our powder and
  • provisions.
  • 18
  • Narrative Continued by the Doctor: End of the First Day's Fighting
  • WE made our best speed across the strip of wood that now divided us from
  • the stockade, and at every step we took the voices of the buccaneers
  • rang nearer. Soon we could hear their footfalls as they ran and the
  • cracking of the branches as they breasted across a bit of thicket.
  • I began to see we should have a brush for it in earnest and looked to my
  • priming.
  • “Captain,” said I, “Trelawney is the dead shot. Give him your gun; his
  • own is useless.”
  • They exchanged guns, and Trelawney, silent and cool as he had been since
  • the beginning of the bustle, hung a moment on his heel to see that all
  • was fit for service. At the same time, observing Gray to be unarmed, I
  • handed him my cutlass. It did all our hearts good to see him spit in his
  • hand, knit his brows, and make the blade sing through the air. It was
  • plain from every line of his body that our new hand was worth his salt.
  • Forty paces farther we came to the edge of the wood and saw the stockade
  • in front of us. We struck the enclosure about the middle of the south
  • side, and almost at the same time, seven mutineers--Job Anderson, the
  • boatswain, at their head--appeared in full cry at the southwestern
  • corner.
  • They paused as if taken aback, and before they recovered, not only the
  • squire and I, but Hunter and Joyce from the block house, had time to
  • fire. The four shots came in rather a scattering volley, but they did
  • the business: one of the enemy actually fell, and the rest, without
  • hesitation, turned and plunged into the trees.
  • After reloading, we walked down the outside of the palisade to see to
  • the fallen enemy. He was stone dead--shot through the heart.
  • We began to rejoice over our good success when just at that moment a
  • pistol cracked in the bush, a ball whistled close past my ear, and poor
  • Tom Redruth stumbled and fell his length on the ground. Both the squire
  • and I returned the shot, but as we had nothing to aim at, it is probable
  • we only wasted powder. Then we reloaded and turned our attention to poor
  • Tom.
  • The captain and Gray were already examining him, and I saw with half an
  • eye that all was over.
  • I believe the readiness of our return volley had scattered the mutineers
  • once more, for we were suffered without further molestation to get the
  • poor old gamekeeper hoisted over the stockade and carried, groaning and
  • bleeding, into the log-house.
  • Poor old fellow, he had not uttered one word of surprise, complaint,
  • fear, or even acquiescence from the very beginning of our troubles till
  • now, when we had laid him down in the log-house to die. He had lain like
  • a Trojan behind his mattress in the gallery; he had followed every order
  • silently, doggedly, and well; he was the oldest of our party by a score
  • of years; and now, sullen, old, serviceable servant, it was he that was
  • to die.
  • The squire dropped down beside him on his knees and kissed his hand,
  • crying like a child.
  • “Be I going, doctor?” he asked.
  • “Tom, my man,” said I, “you're going home.”
  • “I wish I had had a lick at them with the gun first,” he replied.
  • “Tom,” said the squire, “say you forgive me, won't you?”
  • “Would that be respectful like, from me to you, squire?” was the answer.
  • “Howsoever, so be it, amen!”
  • After a little while of silence, he said he thought somebody might read
  • a prayer. “It's the custom, sir,” he added apologetically. And not long
  • after, without another word, he passed away.
  • In the meantime the captain, whom I had observed to be wonderfully
  • swollen about the chest and pockets, had turned out a great many various
  • stores--the British colours, a Bible, a coil of stoutish rope, pen, ink,
  • the log-book, and pounds of tobacco. He had found a longish fir-tree
  • lying felled and trimmed in the enclosure, and with the help of Hunter
  • he had set it up at the corner of the log-house where the trunks crossed
  • and made an angle. Then, climbing on the roof, he had with his own hand
  • bent and run up the colours.
  • This seemed mightily to relieve him. He re-entered the log-house and set
  • about counting up the stores as if nothing else existed. But he had an
  • eye on Tom's passage for all that, and as soon as all was over, came
  • forward with another flag and reverently spread it on the body.
  • “Don't you take on, sir,” he said, shaking the squire's hand. “All's
  • well with him; no fear for a hand that's been shot down in his duty to
  • captain and owner. It mayn't be good divinity, but it's a fact.”
  • Then he pulled me aside.
  • “Dr. Livesey,” he said, “in how many weeks do you and squire expect the
  • consort?”
  • I told him it was a question not of weeks but of months, that if we
  • were not back by the end of August Blandly was to send to find us, but
  • neither sooner nor later. “You can calculate for yourself,” I said.
  • “Why, yes,” returned the captain, scratching his head; “and making a
  • large allowance, sir, for all the gifts of Providence, I should say we
  • were pretty close hauled.”
  • “How do you mean?” I asked.
  • “It's a pity, sir, we lost that second load. That's what I mean,”
  • replied the captain. “As for powder and shot, we'll do. But the rations
  • are short, very short--so short, Dr. Livesey, that we're perhaps as well
  • without that extra mouth.”
  • And he pointed to the dead body under the flag.
  • Just then, with a roar and a whistle, a round-shot passed high above the
  • roof of the log-house and plumped far beyond us in the wood.
  • “Oho!” said the captain. “Blaze away! You've little enough powder
  • already, my lads.”
  • At the second trial, the aim was better, and the ball descended inside
  • the stockade, scattering a cloud of sand but doing no further damage.
  • “Captain,” said the squire, “the house is quite invisible from the ship.
  • It must be the flag they are aiming at. Would it not be wiser to take it
  • in?”
  • “Strike my colours!” cried the captain. “No, sir, not I”; and as soon
  • as he had said the words, I think we all agreed with him. For it was
  • not only a piece of stout, seamanly, good feeling; it was good policy
  • besides and showed our enemies that we despised their cannonade.
  • All through the evening they kept thundering away. Ball after ball flew
  • over or fell short or kicked up the sand in the enclosure, but they had
  • to fire so high that the shot fell dead and buried itself in the soft
  • sand. We had no ricochet to fear, and though one popped in through the
  • roof of the log-house and out again through the floor, we soon got used
  • to that sort of horse-play and minded it no more than cricket.
  • “There is one good thing about all this,” observed the captain; “the
  • wood in front of us is likely clear. The ebb has made a good while; our
  • stores should be uncovered. Volunteers to go and bring in pork.”
  • Gray and Hunter were the first to come forward. Well armed, they stole
  • out of the stockade, but it proved a useless mission. The mutineers were
  • bolder than we fancied or they put more trust in Israel's gunnery. For
  • four or five of them were busy carrying off our stores and wading out
  • with them to one of the gigs that lay close by, pulling an oar or so to
  • hold her steady against the current. Silver was in the stern-sheets in
  • command; and every man of them was now provided with a musket from some
  • secret magazine of their own.
  • The captain sat down to his log, and here is the beginning of the entry:
  • Alexander Smollett, master; David Livesey, ship's
  • doctor; Abraham Gray, carpenter's mate; John
  • Trelawney, owner; John Hunter and Richard Joyce,
  • owner's servants, landsmen--being all that is left
  • faithful of the ship's company--with stores for ten
  • days at short rations, came ashore this day and flew
  • British colours on the log-house in Treasure Island.
  • Thomas Redruth, owner's servant, landsman, shot by the
  • mutineers; James Hawkins, cabin-boy--
  • And at the same time, I was wondering over poor Jim Hawkins' fate.
  • A hail on the land side.
  • “Somebody hailing us,” said Hunter, who was on guard.
  • “Doctor! Squire! Captain! Hullo, Hunter, is that you?” came the cries.
  • And I ran to the door in time to see Jim Hawkins, safe and sound, come
  • climbing over the stockade.
  • 19
  • Narrative Resumed by Jim Hawkins: The Garrison in the Stockade
  • AS soon as Ben Gunn saw the colours he came to a halt, stopped me by the
  • arm, and sat down.
  • “Now,” said he, “there's your friends, sure enough.”
  • “Far more likely it's the mutineers,” I answered.
  • “That!” he cried. “Why, in a place like this, where nobody puts in but
  • gen'lemen of fortune, Silver would fly the Jolly Roger, you don't make
  • no doubt of that. No, that's your friends. There's been blows too, and I
  • reckon your friends has had the best of it; and here they are ashore in
  • the old stockade, as was made years and years ago by Flint. Ah, he was
  • the man to have a headpiece, was Flint! Barring rum, his match were
  • never seen. He were afraid of none, not he; on'y Silver--Silver was that
  • genteel.”
  • “Well,” said I, “that may be so, and so be it; all the more reason that
  • I should hurry on and join my friends.”
  • “Nay, mate,” returned Ben, “not you. You're a good boy, or I'm mistook;
  • but you're on'y a boy, all told. Now, Ben Gunn is fly. Rum wouldn't
  • bring me there, where you're going--not rum wouldn't, till I see your
  • born gen'leman and gets it on his word of honour. And you won't forget
  • my words; 'A precious sight (that's what you'll say), a precious sight
  • more confidence'--and then nips him.”
  • And he pinched me the third time with the same air of cleverness.
  • “And when Ben Gunn is wanted, you know where to find him, Jim. Just
  • wheer you found him today. And him that comes is to have a white thing
  • in his hand, and he's to come alone. Oh! And you'll say this: 'Ben
  • Gunn,' says you, 'has reasons of his own.'”
  • “Well,” said I, “I believe I understand. You have something to propose,
  • and you wish to see the squire or the doctor, and you're to be found
  • where I found you. Is that all?”
  • “And when? says you,” he added. “Why, from about noon observation to
  • about six bells.”
  • “Good,” said I, “and now may I go?”
  • “You won't forget?” he inquired anxiously. “Precious sight, and reasons
  • of his own, says you. Reasons of his own; that's the mainstay; as
  • between man and man. Well, then”--still holding me--“I reckon you can
  • go, Jim. And, Jim, if you was to see Silver, you wouldn't go for to sell
  • Ben Gunn? Wild horses wouldn't draw it from you? No, says you. And if
  • them pirates camp ashore, Jim, what would you say but there'd be widders
  • in the morning?”
  • Here he was interrupted by a loud report, and a cannonball came tearing
  • through the trees and pitched in the sand not a hundred yards from where
  • we two were talking. The next moment each of us had taken to his heels
  • in a different direction.
  • For a good hour to come frequent reports shook the island, and
  • balls kept crashing through the woods. I moved from hiding-place to
  • hiding-place, always pursued, or so it seemed to me, by these terrifying
  • missiles. But towards the end of the bombardment, though still I durst
  • not venture in the direction of the stockade, where the balls fell
  • oftenest, I had begun, in a manner, to pluck up my heart again, and
  • after a long detour to the east, crept down among the shore-side trees.
  • The sun had just set, the sea breeze was rustling and tumbling in the
  • woods and ruffling the grey surface of the anchorage; the tide, too, was
  • far out, and great tracts of sand lay uncovered; the air, after the heat
  • of the day, chilled me through my jacket.
  • The HISPANIOLA still lay where she had anchored; but, sure enough, there
  • was the Jolly Roger--the black flag of piracy--flying from her peak.
  • Even as I looked, there came another red flash and another report that
  • sent the echoes clattering, and one more round-shot whistled through the
  • air. It was the last of the cannonade.
  • I lay for some time watching the bustle which succeeded the attack. Men
  • were demolishing something with axes on the beach near the stockade--the
  • poor jolly-boat, I afterwards discovered. Away, near the mouth of the
  • river, a great fire was glowing among the trees, and between that point
  • and the ship one of the gigs kept coming and going, the men, whom I
  • had seen so gloomy, shouting at the oars like children. But there was a
  • sound in their voices which suggested rum.
  • At length I thought I might return towards the stockade. I was pretty
  • far down on the low, sandy spit that encloses the anchorage to the east,
  • and is joined at half-water to Skeleton Island; and now, as I rose to my
  • feet, I saw, some distance further down the spit and rising from among
  • low bushes, an isolated rock, pretty high, and peculiarly white in
  • colour. It occurred to me that this might be the white rock of which Ben
  • Gunn had spoken and that some day or other a boat might be wanted and I
  • should know where to look for one.
  • Then I skirted among the woods until I had regained the rear, or
  • shoreward side, of the stockade, and was soon warmly welcomed by the
  • faithful party.
  • I had soon told my story and began to look about me. The log-house was
  • made of unsquared trunks of pine--roof, walls, and floor. The latter
  • stood in several places as much as a foot or a foot and a half above the
  • surface of the sand. There was a porch at the door, and under this porch
  • the little spring welled up into an artificial basin of a rather odd
  • kind--no other than a great ship's kettle of iron, with the bottom
  • knocked out, and sunk “to her bearings,” as the captain said, among the
  • sand.
  • Little had been left besides the framework of the house, but in one
  • corner there was a stone slab laid down by way of hearth and an old
  • rusty iron basket to contain the fire.
  • The slopes of the knoll and all the inside of the stockade had been
  • cleared of timber to build the house, and we could see by the stumps
  • what a fine and lofty grove had been destroyed. Most of the soil had
  • been washed away or buried in drift after the removal of the trees; only
  • where the streamlet ran down from the kettle a thick bed of moss and
  • some ferns and little creeping bushes were still green among the sand.
  • Very close around the stockade--too close for defence, they said--the
  • wood still flourished high and dense, all of fir on the land side, but
  • towards the sea with a large admixture of live-oaks.
  • The cold evening breeze, of which I have spoken, whistled through every
  • chink of the rude building and sprinkled the floor with a continual rain
  • of fine sand. There was sand in our eyes, sand in our teeth, sand in our
  • suppers, sand dancing in the spring at the bottom of the kettle, for all
  • the world like porridge beginning to boil. Our chimney was a square hole
  • in the roof; it was but a little part of the smoke that found its way
  • out, and the rest eddied about the house and kept us coughing and piping
  • the eye.
  • Add to this that Gray, the new man, had his face tied up in a bandage
  • for a cut he had got in breaking away from the mutineers and that poor
  • old Tom Redruth, still unburied, lay along the wall, stiff and stark,
  • under the Union Jack.
  • If we had been allowed to sit idle, we should all have fallen in the
  • blues, but Captain Smollett was never the man for that. All hands were
  • called up before him, and he divided us into watches. The doctor and
  • Gray and I for one; the squire, Hunter, and Joyce upon the other. Tired
  • though we all were, two were sent out for firewood; two more were set to
  • dig a grave for Redruth; the doctor was named cook; I was put sentry at
  • the door; and the captain himself went from one to another, keeping up
  • our spirits and lending a hand wherever it was wanted.
  • From time to time the doctor came to the door for a little air and to
  • rest his eyes, which were almost smoked out of his head, and whenever he
  • did so, he had a word for me.
  • “That man Smollett,” he said once, “is a better man than I am. And when
  • I say that it means a deal, Jim.”
  • Another time he came and was silent for a while. Then he put his head on
  • one side, and looked at me.
  • “Is this Ben Gunn a man?” he asked.
  • “I do not know, sir,” said I. “I am not very sure whether he's sane.”
  • “If there's any doubt about the matter, he is,” returned the doctor. “A
  • man who has been three years biting his nails on a desert island, Jim,
  • can't expect to appear as sane as you or me. It doesn't lie in human
  • nature. Was it cheese you said he had a fancy for?”
  • “Yes, sir, cheese,” I answered.
  • “Well, Jim,” says he, “just see the good that comes of being dainty in
  • your food. You've seen my snuff-box, haven't you? And you never saw me
  • take snuff, the reason being that in my snuff-box I carry a piece of
  • Parmesan cheese--a cheese made in Italy, very nutritious. Well, that's
  • for Ben Gunn!”
  • Before supper was eaten we buried old Tom in the sand and stood round
  • him for a while bare-headed in the breeze. A good deal of firewood had
  • been got in, but not enough for the captain's fancy, and he shook his
  • head over it and told us we “must get back to this tomorrow rather
  • livelier.” Then, when we had eaten our pork and each had a good stiff
  • glass of brandy grog, the three chiefs got together in a corner to
  • discuss our prospects.
  • It appears they were at their wits' end what to do, the stores being so
  • low that we must have been starved into surrender long before help came.
  • But our best hope, it was decided, was to kill off the buccaneers until
  • they either hauled down their flag or ran away with the HISPANIOLA. From
  • nineteen they were already reduced to fifteen, two others were wounded,
  • and one at least--the man shot beside the gun--severely wounded, if he
  • were not dead. Every time we had a crack at them, we were to take it,
  • saving our own lives, with the extremest care. And besides that, we had
  • two able allies--rum and the climate.
  • As for the first, though we were about half a mile away, we could hear
  • them roaring and singing late into the night; and as for the second,
  • the doctor staked his wig that, camped where they were in the marsh
  • and unprovided with remedies, the half of them would be on their backs
  • before a week.
  • “So,” he added, “if we are not all shot down first they'll be glad to
  • be packing in the schooner. It's always a ship, and they can get to
  • buccaneering again, I suppose.”
  • “First ship that ever I lost,” said Captain Smollett.
  • I was dead tired, as you may fancy; and when I got to sleep, which was
  • not till after a great deal of tossing, I slept like a log of wood.
  • The rest had long been up and had already breakfasted and increased the
  • pile of firewood by about half as much again when I was wakened by a
  • bustle and the sound of voices.
  • “Flag of truce!” I heard someone say; and then, immediately after, with
  • a cry of surprise, “Silver himself!”
  • And at that, up I jumped, and rubbing my eyes, ran to a loophole in the
  • wall.
  • 20
  • Silver's Embassy
  • SURE enough, there were two men just outside the stockade, one of them
  • waving a white cloth, the other, no less a person than Silver himself,
  • standing placidly by.
  • It was still quite early, and the coldest morning that I think I ever
  • was abroad in--a chill that pierced into the marrow. The sky was bright
  • and cloudless overhead, and the tops of the trees shone rosily in
  • the sun. But where Silver stood with his lieutenant, all was still in
  • shadow, and they waded knee-deep in a low white vapour that had crawled
  • during the night out of the morass. The chill and the vapour taken
  • together told a poor tale of the island. It was plainly a damp,
  • feverish, unhealthy spot.
  • “Keep indoors, men,” said the captain. “Ten to one this is a trick.”
  • Then he hailed the buccaneer.
  • “Who goes? Stand, or we fire.”
  • “Flag of truce,” cried Silver.
  • The captain was in the porch, keeping himself carefully out of the way
  • of a treacherous shot, should any be intended. He turned and spoke to
  • us, “Doctor's watch on the lookout. Dr. Livesey take the north side,
  • if you please; Jim, the east; Gray, west. The watch below, all hands to
  • load muskets. Lively, men, and careful.”
  • And then he turned again to the mutineers.
  • “And what do you want with your flag of truce?” he cried.
  • This time it was the other man who replied.
  • “Cap'n Silver, sir, to come on board and make terms,” he shouted.
  • “Cap'n Silver! Don't know him. Who's he?” cried the captain. And we
  • could hear him adding to himself, “Cap'n, is it? My heart, and here's
  • promotion!”
  • Long John answered for himself. “Me, sir. These poor lads have chosen me
  • cap'n, after your desertion, sir”--laying a particular emphasis upon the
  • word “desertion.” “We're willing to submit, if we can come to terms,
  • and no bones about it. All I ask is your word, Cap'n Smollett, to let me
  • safe and sound out of this here stockade, and one minute to get out o'
  • shot before a gun is fired.”
  • “My man,” said Captain Smollett, “I have not the slightest desire to
  • talk to you. If you wish to talk to me, you can come, that's all. If
  • there's any treachery, it'll be on your side, and the Lord help you.”
  • “That's enough, cap'n,” shouted Long John cheerily. “A word from you's
  • enough. I know a gentleman, and you may lay to that.”
  • We could see the man who carried the flag of truce attempting to hold
  • Silver back. Nor was that wonderful, seeing how cavalier had been the
  • captain's answer. But Silver laughed at him aloud and slapped him on the
  • back as if the idea of alarm had been absurd. Then he advanced to the
  • stockade, threw over his crutch, got a leg up, and with great vigour
  • and skill succeeded in surmounting the fence and dropping safely to the
  • other side.
  • I will confess that I was far too much taken up with what was going on
  • to be of the slightest use as sentry; indeed, I had already deserted
  • my eastern loophole and crept up behind the captain, who had now seated
  • himself on the threshold, with his elbows on his knees, his head in his
  • hands, and his eyes fixed on the water as it bubbled out of the old iron
  • kettle in the sand. He was whistling “Come, Lasses and Lads.”
  • Silver had terrible hard work getting up the knoll. What with the
  • steepness of the incline, the thick tree stumps, and the soft sand, he
  • and his crutch were as helpless as a ship in stays. But he stuck to it
  • like a man in silence, and at last arrived before the captain, whom
  • he saluted in the handsomest style. He was tricked out in his best;
  • an immense blue coat, thick with brass buttons, hung as low as to his
  • knees, and a fine laced hat was set on the back of his head.
  • “Here you are, my man,” said the captain, raising his head. “You had
  • better sit down.”
  • “You ain't a-going to let me inside, cap'n?” complained Long John. “It's
  • a main cold morning, to be sure, sir, to sit outside upon the sand.”
  • “Why, Silver,” said the captain, “if you had pleased to be an honest
  • man, you might have been sitting in your galley. It's your own doing.
  • You're either my ship's cook--and then you were treated handsome--or
  • Cap'n Silver, a common mutineer and pirate, and then you can go hang!”
  • “Well, well, cap'n,” returned the sea-cook, sitting down as he was
  • bidden on the sand, “you'll have to give me a hand up again, that's all.
  • A sweet pretty place you have of it here. Ah, there's Jim! The top of
  • the morning to you, Jim. Doctor, here's my service. Why, there you all
  • are together like a happy family, in a manner of speaking.”
  • “If you have anything to say, my man, better say it,” said the captain.
  • “Right you were, Cap'n Smollett,” replied Silver. “Dooty is dooty, to be
  • sure. Well now, you look here, that was a good lay of yours last
  • night. I don't deny it was a good lay. Some of you pretty handy with a
  • handspike-end. And I'll not deny neither but what some of my people was
  • shook--maybe all was shook; maybe I was shook myself; maybe that's
  • why I'm here for terms. But you mark me, cap'n, it won't do twice, by
  • thunder! We'll have to do sentry-go and ease off a point or so on the
  • rum. Maybe you think we were all a sheet in the wind's eye. But I'll
  • tell you I was sober; I was on'y dog tired; and if I'd awoke a second
  • sooner, I'd 'a caught you at the act, I would. He wasn't dead when I got
  • round to him, not he.”
  • “Well?” says Captain Smollett as cool as can be.
  • All that Silver said was a riddle to him, but you would never have
  • guessed it from his tone. As for me, I began to have an inkling. Ben
  • Gunn's last words came back to my mind. I began to suppose that he had
  • paid the buccaneers a visit while they all lay drunk together round
  • their fire, and I reckoned up with glee that we had only fourteen
  • enemies to deal with.
  • “Well, here it is,” said Silver. “We want that treasure, and we'll have
  • it--that's our point! You would just as soon save your lives, I reckon;
  • and that's yours. You have a chart, haven't you?”
  • “That's as may be,” replied the captain.
  • “Oh, well, you have, I know that,” returned Long John. “You needn't be
  • so husky with a man; there ain't a particle of service in that, and you
  • may lay to it. What I mean is, we want your chart. Now, I never meant
  • you no harm, myself.”
  • “That won't do with me, my man,” interrupted the captain. “We know
  • exactly what you meant to do, and we don't care, for now, you see, you
  • can't do it.”
  • And the captain looked at him calmly and proceeded to fill a pipe.
  • “If Abe Gray--” Silver broke out.
  • “Avast there!” cried Mr. Smollett. “Gray told me nothing, and I asked
  • him nothing; and what's more, I would see you and him and this whole
  • island blown clean out of the water into blazes first. So there's my
  • mind for you, my man, on that.”
  • This little whiff of temper seemed to cool Silver down. He had been
  • growing nettled before, but now he pulled himself together.
  • “Like enough,” said he. “I would set no limits to what gentlemen might
  • consider shipshape, or might not, as the case were. And seein' as how
  • you are about to take a pipe, cap'n, I'll make so free as do likewise.”
  • And he filled a pipe and lighted it; and the two men sat silently
  • smoking for quite a while, now looking each other in the face, now
  • stopping their tobacco, now leaning forward to spit. It was as good as
  • the play to see them.
  • “Now,” resumed Silver, “here it is. You give us the chart to get the
  • treasure by, and drop shooting poor seamen and stoving of their heads in
  • while asleep. You do that, and we'll offer you a choice. Either you come
  • aboard along of us, once the treasure shipped, and then I'll give you my
  • affy-davy, upon my word of honour, to clap you somewhere safe ashore. Or
  • if that ain't to your fancy, some of my hands being rough and having
  • old scores on account of hazing, then you can stay here, you can. We'll
  • divide stores with you, man for man; and I'll give my affy-davy, as
  • before to speak the first ship I sight, and send 'em here to pick you
  • up. Now, you'll own that's talking. Handsomer you couldn't look to get,
  • now you. And I hope”--raising his voice--“that all hands in this here
  • block house will overhaul my words, for what is spoke to one is spoke to
  • all.”
  • Captain Smollett rose from his seat and knocked out the ashes of his
  • pipe in the palm of his left hand.
  • “Is that all?” he asked.
  • “Every last word, by thunder!” answered John. “Refuse that, and you've
  • seen the last of me but musket-balls.”
  • “Very good,” said the captain. “Now you'll hear me. If you'll come up
  • one by one, unarmed, I'll engage to clap you all in irons and take you
  • home to a fair trial in England. If you won't, my name is Alexander
  • Smollett, I've flown my sovereign's colours, and I'll see you all
  • to Davy Jones. You can't find the treasure. You can't sail the
  • ship--there's not a man among you fit to sail the ship. You can't fight
  • us--Gray, there, got away from five of you. Your ship's in irons, Master
  • Silver; you're on a lee shore, and so you'll find. I stand here and tell
  • you so; and they're the last good words you'll get from me, for in the
  • name of heaven, I'll put a bullet in your back when next I meet you.
  • Tramp, my lad. Bundle out of this, please, hand over hand, and double
  • quick.”
  • Silver's face was a picture; his eyes started in his head with wrath. He
  • shook the fire out of his pipe.
  • “Give me a hand up!” he cried.
  • “Not I,” returned the captain.
  • “Who'll give me a hand up?” he roared.
  • Not a man among us moved. Growling the foulest imprecations, he crawled
  • along the sand till he got hold of the porch and could hoist himself
  • again upon his crutch. Then he spat into the spring.
  • “There!” he cried. “That's what I think of ye. Before an hour's out,
  • I'll stove in your old block house like a rum puncheon. Laugh, by
  • thunder, laugh! Before an hour's out, ye'll laugh upon the other side.
  • Them that die'll be the lucky ones.”
  • And with a dreadful oath he stumbled off, ploughed down the sand, was
  • helped across the stockade, after four or five failures, by the man with
  • the flag of truce, and disappeared in an instant afterwards among the
  • trees.
  • 21
  • The Attack
  • AS soon as Silver disappeared, the captain, who had been closely
  • watching him, turned towards the interior of the house and found not a
  • man of us at his post but Gray. It was the first time we had ever seen
  • him angry.
  • “Quarters!” he roared. And then, as we all slunk back to our places,
  • “Gray,” he said, “I'll put your name in the log; you've stood by your
  • duty like a seaman. Mr. Trelawney, I'm surprised at you, sir. Doctor,
  • I thought you had worn the king's coat! If that was how you served at
  • Fontenoy, sir, you'd have been better in your berth.”
  • The doctor's watch were all back at their loopholes, the rest were busy
  • loading the spare muskets, and everyone with a red face, you may be
  • certain, and a flea in his ear, as the saying is.
  • The captain looked on for a while in silence. Then he spoke.
  • “My lads,” said he, “I've given Silver a broadside. I pitched it in
  • red-hot on purpose; and before the hour's out, as he said, we shall be
  • boarded. We're outnumbered, I needn't tell you that, but we fight in
  • shelter; and a minute ago I should have said we fought with discipline.
  • I've no manner of doubt that we can drub them, if you choose.”
  • Then he went the rounds and saw, as he said, that all was clear.
  • On the two short sides of the house, east and west, there were only two
  • loopholes; on the south side where the porch was, two again; and on the
  • north side, five. There was a round score of muskets for the seven
  • of us; the firewood had been built into four piles--tables, you might
  • say--one about the middle of each side, and on each of these tables some
  • ammunition and four loaded muskets were laid ready to the hand of the
  • defenders. In the middle, the cutlasses lay ranged.
  • “Toss out the fire,” said the captain; “the chill is past, and we
  • mustn't have smoke in our eyes.”
  • The iron fire-basket was carried bodily out by Mr. Trelawney, and the
  • embers smothered among sand.
  • “Hawkins hasn't had his breakfast. Hawkins, help yourself, and back to
  • your post to eat it,” continued Captain Smollett. “Lively, now, my lad;
  • you'll want it before you've done. Hunter, serve out a round of brandy
  • to all hands.”
  • And while this was going on, the captain completed, in his own mind, the
  • plan of the defence.
  • “Doctor, you will take the door,” he resumed. “See, and don't expose
  • yourself; keep within, and fire through the porch. Hunter, take the east
  • side, there. Joyce, you stand by the west, my man. Mr. Trelawney, you
  • are the best shot--you and Gray will take this long north side, with the
  • five loopholes; it's there the danger is. If they can get up to it and
  • fire in upon us through our own ports, things would begin to look dirty.
  • Hawkins, neither you nor I are much account at the shooting; we'll stand
  • by to load and bear a hand.”
  • As the captain had said, the chill was past. As soon as the sun had
  • climbed above our girdle of trees, it fell with all its force upon the
  • clearing and drank up the vapours at a draught. Soon the sand was baking
  • and the resin melting in the logs of the block house. Jackets and coats
  • were flung aside, shirts thrown open at the neck and rolled up to the
  • shoulders; and we stood there, each at his post, in a fever of heat and
  • anxiety.
  • An hour passed away.
  • “Hang them!” said the captain. “This is as dull as the doldrums. Gray,
  • whistle for a wind.”
  • And just at that moment came the first news of the attack.
  • “If you please, sir,” said Joyce, “if I see anyone, am I to fire?”
  • “I told you so!” cried the captain.
  • “Thank you, sir,” returned Joyce with the same quiet civility.
  • Nothing followed for a time, but the remark had set us all on the alert,
  • straining ears and eyes--the musketeers with their pieces balanced in
  • their hands, the captain out in the middle of the block house with his
  • mouth very tight and a frown on his face.
  • So some seconds passed, till suddenly Joyce whipped up his musket
  • and fired. The report had scarcely died away ere it was repeated and
  • repeated from without in a scattering volley, shot behind shot, like
  • a string of geese, from every side of the enclosure. Several bullets
  • struck the log-house, but not one entered; and as the smoke cleared away
  • and vanished, the stockade and the woods around it looked as quiet and
  • empty as before. Not a bough waved, not the gleam of a musket-barrel
  • betrayed the presence of our foes.
  • “Did you hit your man?” asked the captain.
  • “No, sir,” replied Joyce. “I believe not, sir.”
  • “Next best thing to tell the truth,” muttered Captain Smollett. “Load
  • his gun, Hawkins. How many should say there were on your side, doctor?”
  • “I know precisely,” said Dr. Livesey. “Three shots were fired on this
  • side. I saw the three flashes--two close together--one farther to the
  • west.”
  • “Three!” repeated the captain. “And how many on yours, Mr. Trelawney?”
  • But this was not so easily answered. There had come many from the
  • north--seven by the squire's computation, eight or nine according to
  • Gray. From the east and west only a single shot had been fired. It was
  • plain, therefore, that the attack would be developed from the north and
  • that on the other three sides we were only to be annoyed by a show of
  • hostilities. But Captain Smollett made no change in his arrangements. If
  • the mutineers succeeded in crossing the stockade, he argued, they would
  • take possession of any unprotected loophole and shoot us down like rats
  • in our own stronghold.
  • Nor had we much time left to us for thought. Suddenly, with a loud
  • huzza, a little cloud of pirates leaped from the woods on the north side
  • and ran straight on the stockade. At the same moment, the fire was once
  • more opened from the woods, and a rifle ball sang through the doorway
  • and knocked the doctor's musket into bits.
  • The boarders swarmed over the fence like monkeys. Squire and Gray fired
  • again and yet again; three men fell, one forwards into the enclosure,
  • two back on the outside. But of these, one was evidently more frightened
  • than hurt, for he was on his feet again in a crack and instantly
  • disappeared among the trees.
  • Two had bit the dust, one had fled, four had made good their footing
  • inside our defences, while from the shelter of the woods seven or eight
  • men, each evidently supplied with several muskets, kept up a hot though
  • useless fire on the log-house.
  • The four who had boarded made straight before them for the building,
  • shouting as they ran, and the men among the trees shouted back to
  • encourage them. Several shots were fired, but such was the hurry of the
  • marksmen that not one appears to have taken effect. In a moment, the
  • four pirates had swarmed up the mound and were upon us.
  • The head of Job Anderson, the boatswain, appeared at the middle
  • loophole.
  • “At 'em, all hands--all hands!” he roared in a voice of thunder.
  • At the same moment, another pirate grasped Hunter's musket by the
  • muzzle, wrenched it from his hands, plucked it through the loophole,
  • and with one stunning blow, laid the poor fellow senseless on the floor.
  • Meanwhile a third, running unharmed all around the house, appeared
  • suddenly in the doorway and fell with his cutlass on the doctor.
  • Our position was utterly reversed. A moment since we were firing, under
  • cover, at an exposed enemy; now it was we who lay uncovered and could
  • not return a blow.
  • The log-house was full of smoke, to which we owed our comparative
  • safety. Cries and confusion, the flashes and reports of pistol-shots,
  • and one loud groan rang in my ears.
  • “Out, lads, out, and fight 'em in the open! Cutlasses!” cried the
  • captain.
  • I snatched a cutlass from the pile, and someone, at the same time
  • snatching another, gave me a cut across the knuckles which I hardly
  • felt. I dashed out of the door into the clear sunlight. Someone was
  • close behind, I knew not whom. Right in front, the doctor was pursuing
  • his assailant down the hill, and just as my eyes fell upon him, beat
  • down his guard and sent him sprawling on his back with a great slash
  • across the face.
  • “Round the house, lads! Round the house!” cried the captain; and even in
  • the hurly-burly, I perceived a change in his voice.
  • Mechanically, I obeyed, turned eastwards, and with my cutlass raised,
  • ran round the corner of the house. Next moment I was face to face
  • with Anderson. He roared aloud, and his hanger went up above his head,
  • flashing in the sunlight. I had not time to be afraid, but as the blow
  • still hung impending, leaped in a trice upon one side, and missing my
  • foot in the soft sand, rolled headlong down the slope.
  • When I had first sallied from the door, the other mutineers had been
  • already swarming up the palisade to make an end of us. One man, in a red
  • night-cap, with his cutlass in his mouth, had even got upon the top and
  • thrown a leg across. Well, so short had been the interval that when I
  • found my feet again all was in the same posture, the fellow with the red
  • night-cap still half-way over, another still just showing his head above
  • the top of the stockade. And yet, in this breath of time, the fight was
  • over and the victory was ours.
  • Gray, following close behind me, had cut down the big boatswain ere
  • he had time to recover from his last blow. Another had been shot at a
  • loophole in the very act of firing into the house and now lay in agony,
  • the pistol still smoking in his hand. A third, as I had seen, the doctor
  • had disposed of at a blow. Of the four who had scaled the palisade, one
  • only remained unaccounted for, and he, having left his cutlass on the
  • field, was now clambering out again with the fear of death upon him.
  • “Fire--fire from the house!” cried the doctor. “And you, lads, back into
  • cover.”
  • But his words were unheeded, no shot was fired, and the last boarder
  • made good his escape and disappeared with the rest into the wood. In
  • three seconds nothing remained of the attacking party but the five who
  • had fallen, four on the inside and one on the outside of the palisade.
  • The doctor and Gray and I ran full speed for shelter. The survivors
  • would soon be back where they had left their muskets, and at any moment
  • the fire might recommence.
  • The house was by this time somewhat cleared of smoke, and we saw at
  • a glance the price we had paid for victory. Hunter lay beside his
  • loophole, stunned; Joyce by his, shot through the head, never to move
  • again; while right in the centre, the squire was supporting the captain,
  • one as pale as the other.
  • “The captain's wounded,” said Mr. Trelawney.
  • “Have they run?” asked Mr. Smollett.
  • “All that could, you may be bound,” returned the doctor; “but there's
  • five of them will never run again.”
  • “Five!” cried the captain. “Come, that's better. Five against three
  • leaves us four to nine. That's better odds than we had at starting. We
  • were seven to nineteen then, or thought we were, and that's as bad to
  • bear.” *
  • *The mutineers were soon only eight in number, for the man shot by Mr.
  • Trelawney on board the schooner died that same evening of his wound. But
  • this was, of course, not known till after by the faithful party.
  • PART FIVE--My Sea Adventure
  • 22
  • How My Sea Adventure Began
  • THERE was no return of the mutineers--not so much as another shot out of
  • the woods. They had “got their rations for that day,” as the captain put
  • it, and we had the place to ourselves and a quiet time to overhaul the
  • wounded and get dinner. Squire and I cooked outside in spite of the
  • danger, and even outside we could hardly tell what we were at, for
  • horror of the loud groans that reached us from the doctor's patients.
  • Out of the eight men who had fallen in the action, only three still
  • breathed--that one of the pirates who had been shot at the loophole,
  • Hunter, and Captain Smollett; and of these, the first two were as good
  • as dead; the mutineer indeed died under the doctor's knife, and Hunter,
  • do what we could, never recovered consciousness in this world. He
  • lingered all day, breathing loudly like the old buccaneer at home in his
  • apoplectic fit, but the bones of his chest had been crushed by the
  • blow and his skull fractured in falling, and some time in the following
  • night, without sign or sound, he went to his Maker.
  • As for the captain, his wounds were grievous indeed, but not dangerous.
  • No organ was fatally injured. Anderson's ball--for it was Job that
  • shot him first--had broken his shoulder-blade and touched the lung, not
  • badly; the second had only torn and displaced some muscles in the calf.
  • He was sure to recover, the doctor said, but in the meantime, and for
  • weeks to come, he must not walk nor move his arm, nor so much as speak
  • when he could help it.
  • My own accidental cut across the knuckles was a flea-bite. Doctor
  • Livesey patched it up with plaster and pulled my ears for me into the
  • bargain.
  • After dinner the squire and the doctor sat by the captain's side awhile
  • in consultation; and when they had talked to their hearts' content, it
  • being then a little past noon, the doctor took up his hat and pistols,
  • girt on a cutlass, put the chart in his pocket, and with a musket over
  • his shoulder crossed the palisade on the north side and set off briskly
  • through the trees.
  • Gray and I were sitting together at the far end of the block house, to
  • be out of earshot of our officers consulting; and Gray took his pipe out
  • of his mouth and fairly forgot to put it back again, so thunder-struck
  • he was at this occurrence.
  • “Why, in the name of Davy Jones,” said he, “is Dr. Livesey mad?”
  • “Why no,” says I. “He's about the last of this crew for that, I take
  • it.”
  • “Well, shipmate,” said Gray, “mad he may not be; but if HE'S not, you
  • mark my words, I am.”
  • “I take it,” replied I, “the doctor has his idea; and if I am right,
  • he's going now to see Ben Gunn.”
  • I was right, as appeared later; but in the meantime, the house being
  • stifling hot and the little patch of sand inside the palisade ablaze
  • with midday sun, I began to get another thought into my head, which was
  • not by any means so right. What I began to do was to envy the doctor
  • walking in the cool shadow of the woods with the birds about him and the
  • pleasant smell of the pines, while I sat grilling, with my clothes
  • stuck to the hot resin, and so much blood about me and so many poor
  • dead bodies lying all around that I took a disgust of the place that was
  • almost as strong as fear.
  • All the time I was washing out the block house, and then washing up
  • the things from dinner, this disgust and envy kept growing stronger
  • and stronger, till at last, being near a bread-bag, and no one then
  • observing me, I took the first step towards my escapade and filled both
  • pockets of my coat with biscuit.
  • I was a fool, if you like, and certainly I was going to do a foolish,
  • over-bold act; but I was determined to do it with all the precautions in
  • my power. These biscuits, should anything befall me, would keep me, at
  • least, from starving till far on in the next day.
  • The next thing I laid hold of was a brace of pistols, and as I already
  • had a powder-horn and bullets, I felt myself well supplied with arms.
  • As for the scheme I had in my head, it was not a bad one in itself. I
  • was to go down the sandy spit that divides the anchorage on the east
  • from the open sea, find the white rock I had observed last evening, and
  • ascertain whether it was there or not that Ben Gunn had hidden his boat,
  • a thing quite worth doing, as I still believe. But as I was certain I
  • should not be allowed to leave the enclosure, my only plan was to take
  • French leave and slip out when nobody was watching, and that was so bad
  • a way of doing it as made the thing itself wrong. But I was only a boy,
  • and I had made my mind up.
  • Well, as things at last fell out, I found an admirable opportunity. The
  • squire and Gray were busy helping the captain with his bandages, the
  • coast was clear, I made a bolt for it over the stockade and into the
  • thickest of the trees, and before my absence was observed I was out of
  • cry of my companions.
  • This was my second folly, far worse than the first, as I left but two
  • sound men to guard the house; but like the first, it was a help towards
  • saving all of us.
  • I took my way straight for the east coast of the island, for I was
  • determined to go down the sea side of the spit to avoid all chance of
  • observation from the anchorage. It was already late in the afternoon,
  • although still warm and sunny. As I continued to thread the tall woods,
  • I could hear from far before me not only the continuous thunder of the
  • surf, but a certain tossing of foliage and grinding of boughs which
  • showed me the sea breeze had set in higher than usual. Soon cool
  • draughts of air began to reach me, and a few steps farther I came forth
  • into the open borders of the grove, and saw the sea lying blue and sunny
  • to the horizon and the surf tumbling and tossing its foam along the
  • beach.
  • I have never seen the sea quiet round Treasure Island. The sun might
  • blaze overhead, the air be without a breath, the surface smooth and
  • blue, but still these great rollers would be running along all the
  • external coast, thundering and thundering by day and night; and I scarce
  • believe there is one spot in the island where a man would be out of
  • earshot of their noise.
  • I walked along beside the surf with great enjoyment, till, thinking
  • I was now got far enough to the south, I took the cover of some thick
  • bushes and crept warily up to the ridge of the spit.
  • Behind me was the sea, in front the anchorage. The sea breeze, as though
  • it had the sooner blown itself out by its unusual violence, was already
  • at an end; it had been succeeded by light, variable airs from the south
  • and south-east, carrying great banks of fog; and the anchorage, under
  • lee of Skeleton Island, lay still and leaden as when first we entered
  • it. The HISPANIOLA, in that unbroken mirror, was exactly portrayed from
  • the truck to the waterline, the Jolly Roger hanging from her peak.
  • Alongside lay one of the gigs, Silver in the stern-sheets--him I could
  • always recognize--while a couple of men were leaning over the stern
  • bulwarks, one of them with a red cap--the very rogue that I had seen
  • some hours before stride-legs upon the palisade. Apparently they were
  • talking and laughing, though at that distance--upwards of a mile--I
  • could, of course, hear no word of what was said. All at once there began
  • the most horrid, unearthly screaming, which at first startled me badly,
  • though I had soon remembered the voice of Captain Flint and even thought
  • I could make out the bird by her bright plumage as she sat perched upon
  • her master's wrist.
  • Soon after, the jolly-boat shoved off and pulled for shore, and the man
  • with the red cap and his comrade went below by the cabin companion.
  • Just about the same time, the sun had gone down behind the Spy-glass,
  • and as the fog was collecting rapidly, it began to grow dark in earnest.
  • I saw I must lose no time if I were to find the boat that evening.
  • The white rock, visible enough above the brush, was still some eighth of
  • a mile further down the spit, and it took me a goodish while to get up
  • with it, crawling, often on all fours, among the scrub. Night had almost
  • come when I laid my hand on its rough sides. Right below it there was
  • an exceedingly small hollow of green turf, hidden by banks and a thick
  • underwood about knee-deep, that grew there very plentifully; and in the
  • centre of the dell, sure enough, a little tent of goat-skins, like what
  • the gipsies carry about with them in England.
  • I dropped into the hollow, lifted the side of the tent, and there was
  • Ben Gunn's boat--home-made if ever anything was home-made; a rude,
  • lop-sided framework of tough wood, and stretched upon that a covering of
  • goat-skin, with the hair inside. The thing was extremely small, even
  • for me, and I can hardly imagine that it could have floated with a
  • full-sized man. There was one thwart set as low as possible, a kind of
  • stretcher in the bows, and a double paddle for propulsion.
  • I had not then seen a coracle, such as the ancient Britons made, but
  • I have seen one since, and I can give you no fairer idea of Ben Gunn's
  • boat than by saying it was like the first and the worst coracle ever
  • made by man. But the great advantage of the coracle it certainly
  • possessed, for it was exceedingly light and portable.
  • Well, now that I had found the boat, you would have thought I had had
  • enough of truantry for once, but in the meantime I had taken another
  • notion and become so obstinately fond of it that I would have carried
  • it out, I believe, in the teeth of Captain Smollett himself. This was
  • to slip out under cover of the night, cut the HISPANIOLA adrift, and let
  • her go ashore where she fancied. I had quite made up my mind that the
  • mutineers, after their repulse of the morning, had nothing nearer their
  • hearts than to up anchor and away to sea; this, I thought, it would be
  • a fine thing to prevent, and now that I had seen how they left their
  • watchmen unprovided with a boat, I thought it might be done with little
  • risk.
  • Down I sat to wait for darkness, and made a hearty meal of biscuit. It
  • was a night out of ten thousand for my purpose. The fog had now buried
  • all heaven. As the last rays of daylight dwindled and disappeared,
  • absolute blackness settled down on Treasure Island. And when, at last,
  • I shouldered the coracle and groped my way stumblingly out of the hollow
  • where I had supped, there were but two points visible on the whole
  • anchorage.
  • One was the great fire on shore, by which the defeated pirates lay
  • carousing in the swamp. The other, a mere blur of light upon the
  • darkness, indicated the position of the anchored ship. She had swung
  • round to the ebb--her bow was now towards me--the only lights on board
  • were in the cabin, and what I saw was merely a reflection on the fog of
  • the strong rays that flowed from the stern window.
  • The ebb had already run some time, and I had to wade through a long belt
  • of swampy sand, where I sank several times above the ankle, before I
  • came to the edge of the retreating water, and wading a little way in,
  • with some strength and dexterity, set my coracle, keel downwards, on the
  • surface.
  • 23
  • The Ebb-tide Runs
  • THE coracle--as I had ample reason to know before I was done with
  • her--was a very safe boat for a person of my height and weight, both
  • buoyant and clever in a seaway; but she was the most cross-grained,
  • lop-sided craft to manage. Do as you pleased, she always made more
  • leeway than anything else, and turning round and round was the manoeuvre
  • she was best at. Even Ben Gunn himself has admitted that she was “queer
  • to handle till you knew her way.”
  • Certainly I did not know her way. She turned in every direction but the
  • one I was bound to go; the most part of the time we were broadside on,
  • and I am very sure I never should have made the ship at all but for the
  • tide. By good fortune, paddle as I pleased, the tide was still sweeping
  • me down; and there lay the HISPANIOLA right in the fairway, hardly to be
  • missed.
  • First she loomed before me like a blot of something yet blacker than
  • darkness, then her spars and hull began to take shape, and the next
  • moment, as it seemed (for, the farther I went, the brisker grew the
  • current of the ebb), I was alongside of her hawser and had laid hold.
  • The hawser was as taut as a bowstring, and the current so strong she
  • pulled upon her anchor. All round the hull, in the blackness, the
  • rippling current bubbled and chattered like a little mountain stream.
  • One cut with my sea-gully and the HISPANIOLA would go humming down the
  • tide.
  • So far so good, but it next occurred to my recollection that a taut
  • hawser, suddenly cut, is a thing as dangerous as a kicking horse. Ten to
  • one, if I were so foolhardy as to cut the HISPANIOLA from her anchor, I
  • and the coracle would be knocked clean out of the water.
  • This brought me to a full stop, and if fortune had not again
  • particularly favoured me, I should have had to abandon my design. But
  • the light airs which had begun blowing from the south-east and south
  • had hauled round after nightfall into the south-west. Just while I was
  • meditating, a puff came, caught the HISPANIOLA, and forced her up into
  • the current; and to my great joy, I felt the hawser slacken in my grasp,
  • and the hand by which I held it dip for a second under water.
  • With that I made my mind up, took out my gully, opened it with my teeth,
  • and cut one strand after another, till the vessel swung only by two.
  • Then I lay quiet, waiting to sever these last when the strain should be
  • once more lightened by a breath of wind.
  • All this time I had heard the sound of loud voices from the cabin, but
  • to say truth, my mind had been so entirely taken up with other thoughts
  • that I had scarcely given ear. Now, however, when I had nothing else to
  • do, I began to pay more heed.
  • One I recognized for the coxswain's, Israel Hands, that had been Flint's
  • gunner in former days. The other was, of course, my friend of the red
  • night-cap. Both men were plainly the worse of drink, and they were still
  • drinking, for even while I was listening, one of them, with a drunken
  • cry, opened the stern window and threw out something, which I divined to
  • be an empty bottle. But they were not only tipsy; it was plain that they
  • were furiously angry. Oaths flew like hailstones, and every now and
  • then there came forth such an explosion as I thought was sure to end
  • in blows. But each time the quarrel passed off and the voices grumbled
  • lower for a while, until the next crisis came and in its turn passed
  • away without result.
  • On shore, I could see the glow of the great camp-fire burning warmly
  • through the shore-side trees. Someone was singing, a dull, old, droning
  • sailor's song, with a droop and a quaver at the end of every verse,
  • and seemingly no end to it at all but the patience of the singer. I had
  • heard it on the voyage more than once and remembered these words:
  • “But one man of her crew alive,
  • What put to sea with seventy-five.”
  • And I thought it was a ditty rather too dolefully appropriate for a
  • company that had met such cruel losses in the morning. But, indeed, from
  • what I saw, all these buccaneers were as callous as the sea they sailed
  • on.
  • At last the breeze came; the schooner sidled and drew nearer in the
  • dark; I felt the hawser slacken once more, and with a good, tough
  • effort, cut the last fibres through.
  • The breeze had but little action on the coracle, and I was almost
  • instantly swept against the bows of the HISPANIOLA. At the same time,
  • the schooner began to turn upon her heel, spinning slowly, end for end,
  • across the current.
  • I wrought like a fiend, for I expected every moment to be swamped; and
  • since I found I could not push the coracle directly off, I now shoved
  • straight astern. At length I was clear of my dangerous neighbour, and
  • just as I gave the last impulsion, my hands came across a light cord
  • that was trailing overboard across the stern bulwarks. Instantly I
  • grasped it.
  • Why I should have done so I can hardly say. It was at first mere
  • instinct, but once I had it in my hands and found it fast, curiosity
  • began to get the upper hand, and I determined I should have one look
  • through the cabin window.
  • I pulled in hand over hand on the cord, and when I judged myself near
  • enough, rose at infinite risk to about half my height and thus commanded
  • the roof and a slice of the interior of the cabin.
  • By this time the schooner and her little consort were gliding pretty
  • swiftly through the water; indeed, we had already fetched up level with
  • the camp-fire. The ship was talking, as sailors say, loudly, treading
  • the innumerable ripples with an incessant weltering splash; and until I
  • got my eye above the window-sill I could not comprehend why the watchmen
  • had taken no alarm. One glance, however, was sufficient; and it was
  • only one glance that I durst take from that unsteady skiff. It showed me
  • Hands and his companion locked together in deadly wrestle, each with a
  • hand upon the other's throat.
  • I dropped upon the thwart again, none too soon, for I was near
  • overboard. I could see nothing for the moment but these two furious,
  • encrimsoned faces swaying together under the smoky lamp, and I shut my
  • eyes to let them grow once more familiar with the darkness.
  • The endless ballad had come to an end at last, and the whole diminished
  • company about the camp-fire had broken into the chorus I had heard so
  • often:
  • “Fifteen men on the dead man's chest--
  • Yo-ho-ho, and a bottle of rum!
  • Drink and the devil had done for the rest--
  • Yo-ho-ho, and a bottle of rum!”
  • I was just thinking how busy drink and the devil were at that very
  • moment in the cabin of the HISPANIOLA, when I was surprised by a sudden
  • lurch of the coracle. At the same moment, she yawed sharply and seemed
  • to change her course. The speed in the meantime had strangely increased.
  • I opened my eyes at once. All round me were little ripples, combing
  • over with a sharp, bristling sound and slightly phosphorescent. The
  • HISPANIOLA herself, a few yards in whose wake I was still being whirled
  • along, seemed to stagger in her course, and I saw her spars toss a
  • little against the blackness of the night; nay, as I looked longer, I
  • made sure she also was wheeling to the southward.
  • I glanced over my shoulder, and my heart jumped against my ribs. There,
  • right behind me, was the glow of the camp-fire. The current had turned
  • at right angles, sweeping round along with it the tall schooner and
  • the little dancing coracle; ever quickening, ever bubbling higher, ever
  • muttering louder, it went spinning through the narrows for the open sea.
  • Suddenly the schooner in front of me gave a violent yaw, turning,
  • perhaps, through twenty degrees; and almost at the same moment one
  • shout followed another from on board; I could hear feet pounding on
  • the companion ladder and I knew that the two drunkards had at last been
  • interrupted in their quarrel and awakened to a sense of their disaster.
  • I lay down flat in the bottom of that wretched skiff and devoutly
  • recommended my spirit to its Maker. At the end of the straits, I
  • made sure we must fall into some bar of raging breakers, where all my
  • troubles would be ended speedily; and though I could, perhaps, bear to
  • die, I could not bear to look upon my fate as it approached.
  • So I must have lain for hours, continually beaten to and fro upon the
  • billows, now and again wetted with flying sprays, and never ceasing to
  • expect death at the next plunge. Gradually weariness grew upon me; a
  • numbness, an occasional stupor, fell upon my mind even in the midst of
  • my terrors, until sleep at last supervened and in my sea-tossed coracle
  • I lay and dreamed of home and the old Admiral Benbow.
  • 24
  • The Cruise of the Coracle
  • IT was broad day when I awoke and found myself tossing at the south-west
  • end of Treasure Island. The sun was up but was still hid from me behind
  • the great bulk of the Spy-glass, which on this side descended almost to
  • the sea in formidable cliffs.
  • Haulbowline Head and Mizzen-mast Hill were at my elbow, the hill bare
  • and dark, the head bound with cliffs forty or fifty feet high and
  • fringed with great masses of fallen rock. I was scarce a quarter of a
  • mile to seaward, and it was my first thought to paddle in and land.
  • That notion was soon given over. Among the fallen rocks the breakers
  • spouted and bellowed; loud reverberations, heavy sprays flying and
  • falling, succeeded one another from second to second; and I saw myself,
  • if I ventured nearer, dashed to death upon the rough shore or spending
  • my strength in vain to scale the beetling crags.
  • Nor was that all, for crawling together on flat tables of rock or
  • letting themselves drop into the sea with loud reports I beheld huge
  • slimy monsters--soft snails, as it were, of incredible bigness--two
  • or three score of them together, making the rocks to echo with their
  • barkings.
  • I have understood since that they were sea lions, and entirely harmless.
  • But the look of them, added to the difficulty of the shore and the
  • high running of the surf, was more than enough to disgust me of that
  • landing-place. I felt willing rather to starve at sea than to confront
  • such perils.
  • In the meantime I had a better chance, as I supposed, before me. North
  • of Haulbowline Head, the land runs in a long way, leaving at low tide
  • a long stretch of yellow sand. To the north of that, again, there comes
  • another cape--Cape of the Woods, as it was marked upon the chart--buried
  • in tall green pines, which descended to the margin of the sea.
  • I remembered what Silver had said about the current that sets northward
  • along the whole west coast of Treasure Island, and seeing from my
  • position that I was already under its influence, I preferred to leave
  • Haulbowline Head behind me and reserve my strength for an attempt to
  • land upon the kindlier-looking Cape of the Woods.
  • There was a great, smooth swell upon the sea. The wind blowing steady
  • and gentle from the south, there was no contrariety between that and the
  • current, and the billows rose and fell unbroken.
  • Had it been otherwise, I must long ago have perished; but as it was,
  • it is surprising how easily and securely my little and light boat could
  • ride. Often, as I still lay at the bottom and kept no more than an eye
  • above the gunwale, I would see a big blue summit heaving close above me;
  • yet the coracle would but bounce a little, dance as if on springs, and
  • subside on the other side into the trough as lightly as a bird.
  • I began after a little to grow very bold and sat up to try my skill at
  • paddling. But even a small change in the disposition of the weight will
  • produce violent changes in the behaviour of a coracle. And I had hardly
  • moved before the boat, giving up at once her gentle dancing movement,
  • ran straight down a slope of water so steep that it made me giddy, and
  • struck her nose, with a spout of spray, deep into the side of the next
  • wave.
  • I was drenched and terrified, and fell instantly back into my old
  • position, whereupon the coracle seemed to find her head again and led
  • me as softly as before among the billows. It was plain she was not to be
  • interfered with, and at that rate, since I could in no way influence her
  • course, what hope had I left of reaching land?
  • I began to be horribly frightened, but I kept my head, for all that.
  • First, moving with all care, I gradually baled out the coracle with my
  • sea-cap; then, getting my eye once more above the gunwale, I set myself
  • to study how it was she managed to slip so quietly through the rollers.
  • I found each wave, instead of the big, smooth glossy mountain it looks
  • from shore or from a vessel's deck, was for all the world like any range
  • of hills on dry land, full of peaks and smooth places and valleys. The
  • coracle, left to herself, turning from side to side, threaded, so to
  • speak, her way through these lower parts and avoided the steep slopes
  • and higher, toppling summits of the wave.
  • “Well, now,” thought I to myself, “it is plain I must lie where I am and
  • not disturb the balance; but it is plain also that I can put the paddle
  • over the side and from time to time, in smooth places, give her a shove
  • or two towards land.” No sooner thought upon than done. There I lay on
  • my elbows in the most trying attitude, and every now and again gave a
  • weak stroke or two to turn her head to shore.
  • It was very tiring and slow work, yet I did visibly gain ground; and as
  • we drew near the Cape of the Woods, though I saw I must infallibly
  • miss that point, I had still made some hundred yards of easting. I was,
  • indeed, close in. I could see the cool green tree-tops swaying together
  • in the breeze, and I felt sure I should make the next promontory without
  • fail.
  • It was high time, for I now began to be tortured with thirst. The glow
  • of the sun from above, its thousandfold reflection from the waves, the
  • sea-water that fell and dried upon me, caking my very lips with salt,
  • combined to make my throat burn and my brain ache. The sight of the
  • trees so near at hand had almost made me sick with longing, but the
  • current had soon carried me past the point, and as the next reach of sea
  • opened out, I beheld a sight that changed the nature of my thoughts.
  • Right in front of me, not half a mile away, I beheld the HISPANIOLA
  • under sail. I made sure, of course, that I should be taken; but I was
  • so distressed for want of water that I scarce knew whether to be glad
  • or sorry at the thought, and long before I had come to a conclusion,
  • surprise had taken entire possession of my mind and I could do nothing
  • but stare and wonder.
  • The HISPANIOLA was under her main-sail and two jibs, and the beautiful
  • white canvas shone in the sun like snow or silver. When I first
  • sighted her, all her sails were drawing; she was lying a course about
  • north-west, and I presumed the men on board were going round the island
  • on their way back to the anchorage. Presently she began to fetch more
  • and more to the westward, so that I thought they had sighted me and were
  • going about in chase. At last, however, she fell right into the wind's
  • eye, was taken dead aback, and stood there awhile helpless, with her
  • sails shivering.
  • “Clumsy fellows,” said I; “they must still be drunk as owls.” And I
  • thought how Captain Smollett would have set them skipping.
  • Meanwhile the schooner gradually fell off and filled again upon another
  • tack, sailed swiftly for a minute or so, and brought up once more dead
  • in the wind's eye. Again and again was this repeated. To and fro, up and
  • down, north, south, east, and west, the HISPANIOLA sailed by swoops
  • and dashes, and at each repetition ended as she had begun, with idly
  • flapping canvas. It became plain to me that nobody was steering. And if
  • so, where were the men? Either they were dead drunk or had deserted her,
  • I thought, and perhaps if I could get on board I might return the vessel
  • to her captain.
  • The current was bearing coracle and schooner southward at an equal rate.
  • As for the latter's sailing, it was so wild and intermittent, and she
  • hung each time so long in irons, that she certainly gained nothing, if
  • she did not even lose. If only I dared to sit up and paddle, I made
  • sure that I could overhaul her. The scheme had an air of adventure
  • that inspired me, and the thought of the water breaker beside the fore
  • companion doubled my growing courage.
  • Up I got, was welcomed almost instantly by another cloud of spray, but
  • this time stuck to my purpose and set myself, with all my strength and
  • caution, to paddle after the unsteered HISPANIOLA. Once I shipped a sea
  • so heavy that I had to stop and bail, with my heart fluttering like
  • a bird, but gradually I got into the way of the thing and guided my
  • coracle among the waves, with only now and then a blow upon her bows and
  • a dash of foam in my face.
  • I was now gaining rapidly on the schooner; I could see the brass glisten
  • on the tiller as it banged about, and still no soul appeared upon her
  • decks. I could not choose but suppose she was deserted. If not, the men
  • were lying drunk below, where I might batten them down, perhaps, and do
  • what I chose with the ship.
  • For some time she had been doing the worse thing possible for
  • me--standing still. She headed nearly due south, yawing, of course, all
  • the time. Each time she fell off, her sails partly filled, and these
  • brought her in a moment right to the wind again. I have said this was
  • the worst thing possible for me, for helpless as she looked in this
  • situation, with the canvas cracking like cannon and the blocks trundling
  • and banging on the deck, she still continued to run away from me, not
  • only with the speed of the current, but by the whole amount of her
  • leeway, which was naturally great.
  • But now, at last, I had my chance. The breeze fell for some seconds,
  • very low, and the current gradually turning her, the HISPANIOLA revolved
  • slowly round her centre and at last presented me her stern, with the
  • cabin window still gaping open and the lamp over the table still burning
  • on into the day. The main-sail hung drooped like a banner. She was
  • stock-still but for the current.
  • For the last little while I had even lost, but now redoubling my
  • efforts, I began once more to overhaul the chase.
  • I was not a hundred yards from her when the wind came again in a clap;
  • she filled on the port tack and was off again, stooping and skimming
  • like a swallow.
  • My first impulse was one of despair, but my second was towards joy.
  • Round she came, till she was broadside on to me--round still till she
  • had covered a half and then two thirds and then three quarters of the
  • distance that separated us. I could see the waves boiling white under
  • her forefoot. Immensely tall she looked to me from my low station in the
  • coracle.
  • And then, of a sudden, I began to comprehend. I had scarce time to
  • think--scarce time to act and save myself. I was on the summit of one
  • swell when the schooner came stooping over the next. The bowsprit was
  • over my head. I sprang to my feet and leaped, stamping the coracle under
  • water. With one hand I caught the jib-boom, while my foot was lodged
  • between the stay and the brace; and as I still clung there panting, a
  • dull blow told me that the schooner had charged down upon and struck the
  • coracle and that I was left without retreat on the HISPANIOLA.
  • 25
  • I Strike the Jolly Roger
  • I HAD scarce gained a position on the bowsprit when the flying jib
  • flapped and filled upon the other tack, with a report like a gun. The
  • schooner trembled to her keel under the reverse, but next moment, the
  • other sails still drawing, the jib flapped back again and hung idle.
  • This had nearly tossed me off into the sea; and now I lost no time,
  • crawled back along the bowsprit, and tumbled head foremost on the deck.
  • I was on the lee side of the forecastle, and the mainsail, which was
  • still drawing, concealed from me a certain portion of the after-deck.
  • Not a soul was to be seen. The planks, which had not been swabbed since
  • the mutiny, bore the print of many feet, and an empty bottle, broken by
  • the neck, tumbled to and fro like a live thing in the scuppers.
  • Suddenly the HISPANIOLA came right into the wind. The jibs behind me
  • cracked aloud, the rudder slammed to, the whole ship gave a sickening
  • heave and shudder, and at the same moment the main-boom swung inboard,
  • the sheet groaning in the blocks, and showed me the lee after-deck.
  • There were the two watchmen, sure enough: red-cap on his back, as stiff
  • as a handspike, with his arms stretched out like those of a crucifix and
  • his teeth showing through his open lips; Israel Hands propped against
  • the bulwarks, his chin on his chest, his hands lying open before him on
  • the deck, his face as white, under its tan, as a tallow candle.
  • For a while the ship kept bucking and sidling like a vicious horse, the
  • sails filling, now on one tack, now on another, and the boom swinging to
  • and fro till the mast groaned aloud under the strain. Now and again too
  • there would come a cloud of light sprays over the bulwark and a heavy
  • blow of the ship's bows against the swell; so much heavier weather was
  • made of it by this great rigged ship than by my home-made, lop-sided
  • coracle, now gone to the bottom of the sea.
  • At every jump of the schooner, red-cap slipped to and fro, but--what was
  • ghastly to behold--neither his attitude nor his fixed teeth-disclosing
  • grin was anyway disturbed by this rough usage. At every jump too, Hands
  • appeared still more to sink into himself and settle down upon the
  • deck, his feet sliding ever the farther out, and the whole body canting
  • towards the stern, so that his face became, little by little, hid
  • from me; and at last I could see nothing beyond his ear and the frayed
  • ringlet of one whisker.
  • At the same time, I observed, around both of them, splashes of dark
  • blood upon the planks and began to feel sure that they had killed each
  • other in their drunken wrath.
  • While I was thus looking and wondering, in a calm moment, when the ship
  • was still, Israel Hands turned partly round and with a low moan writhed
  • himself back to the position in which I had seen him first. The moan,
  • which told of pain and deadly weakness, and the way in which his jaw
  • hung open went right to my heart. But when I remembered the talk I had
  • overheard from the apple barrel, all pity left me.
  • I walked aft until I reached the main-mast.
  • “Come aboard, Mr. Hands,” I said ironically.
  • He rolled his eyes round heavily, but he was too far gone to express
  • surprise. All he could do was to utter one word, “Brandy.”
  • It occurred to me there was no time to lose, and dodging the boom as it
  • once more lurched across the deck, I slipped aft and down the companion
  • stairs into the cabin.
  • It was such a scene of confusion as you can hardly fancy. All the
  • lockfast places had been broken open in quest of the chart. The floor
  • was thick with mud where ruffians had sat down to drink or consult after
  • wading in the marshes round their camp. The bulkheads, all painted in
  • clear white and beaded round with gilt, bore a pattern of dirty hands.
  • Dozens of empty bottles clinked together in corners to the rolling of
  • the ship. One of the doctor's medical books lay open on the table, half
  • of the leaves gutted out, I suppose, for pipelights. In the midst of all
  • this the lamp still cast a smoky glow, obscure and brown as umber.
  • I went into the cellar; all the barrels were gone, and of the bottles
  • a most surprising number had been drunk out and thrown away. Certainly,
  • since the mutiny began, not a man of them could ever have been sober.
  • Foraging about, I found a bottle with some brandy left, for Hands; and
  • for myself I routed out some biscuit, some pickled fruits, a great bunch
  • of raisins, and a piece of cheese. With these I came on deck, put down
  • my own stock behind the rudder head and well out of the coxswain's
  • reach, went forward to the water-breaker, and had a good deep drink of
  • water, and then, and not till then, gave Hands the brandy.
  • He must have drunk a gill before he took the bottle from his mouth.
  • “Aye,” said he, “by thunder, but I wanted some o' that!”
  • I had sat down already in my own corner and begun to eat.
  • “Much hurt?” I asked him.
  • He grunted, or rather, I might say, he barked.
  • “If that doctor was aboard,” he said, “I'd be right enough in a couple
  • of turns, but I don't have no manner of luck, you see, and that's what's
  • the matter with me. As for that swab, he's good and dead, he is,” he
  • added, indicating the man with the red cap. “He warn't no seaman anyhow.
  • And where mought you have come from?”
  • “Well,” said I, “I've come aboard to take possession of this ship,
  • Mr. Hands; and you'll please regard me as your captain until further
  • notice.”
  • He looked at me sourly enough but said nothing. Some of the colour had
  • come back into his cheeks, though he still looked very sick and still
  • continued to slip out and settle down as the ship banged about.
  • “By the by,” I continued, “I can't have these colours, Mr. Hands; and by
  • your leave, I'll strike 'em. Better none than these.”
  • And again dodging the boom, I ran to the colour lines, handed down their
  • cursed black flag, and chucked it overboard.
  • “God save the king!” said I, waving my cap. “And there's an end to
  • Captain Silver!”
  • He watched me keenly and slyly, his chin all the while on his breast.
  • “I reckon,” he said at last, “I reckon, Cap'n Hawkins, you'll kind of
  • want to get ashore now. S'pose we talks.”
  • “Why, yes,” says I, “with all my heart, Mr. Hands. Say on.” And I went
  • back to my meal with a good appetite.
  • “This man,” he began, nodding feebly at the corpse “--O'Brien were his
  • name, a rank Irelander--this man and me got the canvas on her, meaning
  • for to sail her back. Well, HE'S dead now, he is--as dead as bilge; and
  • who's to sail this ship, I don't see. Without I gives you a hint, you
  • ain't that man, as far's I can tell. Now, look here, you gives me food
  • and drink and a old scarf or ankecher to tie my wound up, you do, and
  • I'll tell you how to sail her, and that's about square all round, I take
  • it.”
  • “I'll tell you one thing,” says I: “I'm not going back to Captain Kidd's
  • anchorage. I mean to get into North Inlet and beach her quietly there.”
  • “To be sure you did,” he cried. “Why, I ain't sich an infernal lubber
  • after all. I can see, can't I? I've tried my fling, I have, and I've
  • lost, and it's you has the wind of me. North Inlet? Why, I haven't no
  • ch'ice, not I! I'd help you sail her up to Execution Dock, by thunder!
  • So I would.”
  • Well, as it seemed to me, there was some sense in this. We struck our
  • bargain on the spot. In three minutes I had the HISPANIOLA sailing
  • easily before the wind along the coast of Treasure Island, with good
  • hopes of turning the northern point ere noon and beating down again as
  • far as North Inlet before high water, when we might beach her safely and
  • wait till the subsiding tide permitted us to land.
  • Then I lashed the tiller and went below to my own chest, where I got a
  • soft silk handkerchief of my mother's. With this, and with my aid, Hands
  • bound up the great bleeding stab he had received in the thigh, and after
  • he had eaten a little and had a swallow or two more of the brandy, he
  • began to pick up visibly, sat straighter up, spoke louder and clearer,
  • and looked in every way another man.
  • The breeze served us admirably. We skimmed before it like a bird, the
  • coast of the island flashing by and the view changing every minute.
  • Soon we were past the high lands and bowling beside low, sandy country,
  • sparsely dotted with dwarf pines, and soon we were beyond that again
  • and had turned the corner of the rocky hill that ends the island on the
  • north.
  • I was greatly elated with my new command, and pleased with the bright,
  • sunshiny weather and these different prospects of the coast. I had now
  • plenty of water and good things to eat, and my conscience, which had
  • smitten me hard for my desertion, was quieted by the great conquest I
  • had made. I should, I think, have had nothing left me to desire but for
  • the eyes of the coxswain as they followed me derisively about the deck
  • and the odd smile that appeared continually on his face. It was a smile
  • that had in it something both of pain and weakness--a haggard old man's
  • smile; but there was, besides that, a grain of derision, a shadow of
  • treachery, in his expression as he craftily watched, and watched, and
  • watched me at my work.
  • 26
  • Israel Hands
  • THE wind, serving us to a desire, now hauled into the west. We could run
  • so much the easier from the north-east corner of the island to the mouth
  • of the North Inlet. Only, as we had no power to anchor and dared not
  • beach her till the tide had flowed a good deal farther, time hung on our
  • hands. The coxswain told me how to lay the ship to; after a good many
  • trials I succeeded, and we both sat in silence over another meal.
  • “Cap'n,” said he at length with that same uncomfortable smile, “here's
  • my old shipmate, O'Brien; s'pose you was to heave him overboard. I ain't
  • partic'lar as a rule, and I don't take no blame for settling his hash,
  • but I don't reckon him ornamental now, do you?”
  • “I'm not strong enough, and I don't like the job; and there he lies, for
  • me,” said I.
  • “This here's an unlucky ship, this HISPANIOLA, Jim,” he went on,
  • blinking. “There's a power of men been killed in this HISPANIOLA--a
  • sight o' poor seamen dead and gone since you and me took ship to
  • Bristol. I never seen sich dirty luck, not I. There was this here
  • O'Brien now--he's dead, ain't he? Well now, I'm no scholar, and you're a
  • lad as can read and figure, and to put it straight, do you take it as a
  • dead man is dead for good, or do he come alive again?”
  • “You can kill the body, Mr. Hands, but not the spirit; you must know
  • that already,” I replied. “O'Brien there is in another world, and may be
  • watching us.”
  • “Ah!” says he. “Well, that's unfort'nate--appears as if killing parties
  • was a waste of time. Howsomever, sperrits don't reckon for much, by what
  • I've seen. I'll chance it with the sperrits, Jim. And now, you've spoke
  • up free, and I'll take it kind if you'd step down into that there cabin
  • and get me a--well, a--shiver my timbers! I can't hit the name on 't;
  • well, you get me a bottle of wine, Jim--this here brandy's too strong
  • for my head.”
  • Now, the coxswain's hesitation seemed to be unnatural, and as for the
  • notion of his preferring wine to brandy, I entirely disbelieved it. The
  • whole story was a pretext. He wanted me to leave the deck--so much was
  • plain; but with what purpose I could in no way imagine. His eyes never
  • met mine; they kept wandering to and fro, up and down, now with a look
  • to the sky, now with a flitting glance upon the dead O'Brien. All the
  • time he kept smiling and putting his tongue out in the most guilty,
  • embarrassed manner, so that a child could have told that he was bent on
  • some deception. I was prompt with my answer, however, for I saw where
  • my advantage lay and that with a fellow so densely stupid I could easily
  • conceal my suspicions to the end.
  • “Some wine?” I said. “Far better. Will you have white or red?”
  • “Well, I reckon it's about the blessed same to me, shipmate,” he
  • replied; “so it's strong, and plenty of it, what's the odds?”
  • “All right,” I answered. “I'll bring you port, Mr. Hands. But I'll have
  • to dig for it.”
  • With that I scuttled down the companion with all the noise I could,
  • slipped off my shoes, ran quietly along the sparred gallery, mounted the
  • forecastle ladder, and popped my head out of the fore companion. I
  • knew he would not expect to see me there, yet I took every precaution
  • possible, and certainly the worst of my suspicions proved too true.
  • He had risen from his position to his hands and knees, and though his
  • leg obviously hurt him pretty sharply when he moved--for I could hear
  • him stifle a groan--yet it was at a good, rattling rate that he trailed
  • himself across the deck. In half a minute he had reached the port
  • scuppers and picked, out of a coil of rope, a long knife, or rather a
  • short dirk, discoloured to the hilt with blood. He looked upon it for
  • a moment, thrusting forth his under jaw, tried the point upon his hand,
  • and then, hastily concealing it in the bosom of his jacket, trundled
  • back again into his old place against the bulwark.
  • This was all that I required to know. Israel could move about, he was
  • now armed, and if he had been at so much trouble to get rid of me,
  • it was plain that I was meant to be the victim. What he would do
  • afterwards--whether he would try to crawl right across the island from
  • North Inlet to the camp among the swamps or whether he would fire Long
  • Tom, trusting that his own comrades might come first to help him--was,
  • of course, more than I could say.
  • Yet I felt sure that I could trust him in one point, since in that
  • our interests jumped together, and that was in the disposition of
  • the schooner. We both desired to have her stranded safe enough, in a
  • sheltered place, and so that, when the time came, she could be got off
  • again with as little labour and danger as might be; and until that was
  • done I considered that my life would certainly be spared.
  • While I was thus turning the business over in my mind, I had not been
  • idle with my body. I had stolen back to the cabin, slipped once more
  • into my shoes, and laid my hand at random on a bottle of wine, and now,
  • with this for an excuse, I made my reappearance on the deck.
  • Hands lay as I had left him, all fallen together in a bundle and with
  • his eyelids lowered as though he were too weak to bear the light. He
  • looked up, however, at my coming, knocked the neck off the bottle like
  • a man who had done the same thing often, and took a good swig, with his
  • favourite toast of “Here's luck!” Then he lay quiet for a little, and
  • then, pulling out a stick of tobacco, begged me to cut him a quid.
  • “Cut me a junk o' that,” says he, “for I haven't no knife and hardly
  • strength enough, so be as I had. Ah, Jim, Jim, I reckon I've missed
  • stays! Cut me a quid, as'll likely be the last, lad, for I'm for my long
  • home, and no mistake.”
  • “Well,” said I, “I'll cut you some tobacco, but if I was you and thought
  • myself so badly, I would go to my prayers like a Christian man.”
  • “Why?” said he. “Now, you tell me why.”
  • “Why?” I cried. “You were asking me just now about the dead. You've
  • broken your trust; you've lived in sin and lies and blood; there's a man
  • you killed lying at your feet this moment, and you ask me why! For God's
  • mercy, Mr. Hands, that's why.”
  • I spoke with a little heat, thinking of the bloody dirk he had hidden
  • in his pocket and designed, in his ill thoughts, to end me with. He,
  • for his part, took a great draught of the wine and spoke with the most
  • unusual solemnity.
  • “For thirty years,” he said, “I've sailed the seas and seen good and
  • bad, better and worse, fair weather and foul, provisions running out,
  • knives going, and what not. Well, now I tell you, I never seen good come
  • o' goodness yet. Him as strikes first is my fancy; dead men don't bite;
  • them's my views--amen, so be it. And now, you look here,” he added,
  • suddenly changing his tone, “we've had about enough of this foolery. The
  • tide's made good enough by now. You just take my orders, Cap'n Hawkins,
  • and we'll sail slap in and be done with it.”
  • All told, we had scarce two miles to run; but the navigation was
  • delicate, the entrance to this northern anchorage was not only narrow
  • and shoal, but lay east and west, so that the schooner must be nicely
  • handled to be got in. I think I was a good, prompt subaltern, and I am
  • very sure that Hands was an excellent pilot, for we went about and about
  • and dodged in, shaving the banks, with a certainty and a neatness that
  • were a pleasure to behold.
  • Scarcely had we passed the heads before the land closed around us. The
  • shores of North Inlet were as thickly wooded as those of the southern
  • anchorage, but the space was longer and narrower and more like, what in
  • truth it was, the estuary of a river. Right before us, at the southern
  • end, we saw the wreck of a ship in the last stages of dilapidation. It
  • had been a great vessel of three masts but had lain so long exposed to
  • the injuries of the weather that it was hung about with great webs of
  • dripping seaweed, and on the deck of it shore bushes had taken root and
  • now flourished thick with flowers. It was a sad sight, but it showed us
  • that the anchorage was calm.
  • “Now,” said Hands, “look there; there's a pet bit for to beach a ship
  • in. Fine flat sand, never a cat's paw, trees all around of it, and
  • flowers a-blowing like a garding on that old ship.”
  • “And once beached,” I inquired, “how shall we get her off again?”
  • “Why, so,” he replied: “you take a line ashore there on the other side
  • at low water, take a turn about one of them big pines; bring it back,
  • take a turn around the capstan, and lie to for the tide. Come high
  • water, all hands take a pull upon the line, and off she comes as sweet
  • as natur'. And now, boy, you stand by. We're near the bit now, and she's
  • too much way on her. Starboard a little--so--steady--starboard--larboard
  • a little--steady--steady!”
  • So he issued his commands, which I breathlessly obeyed, till, all of a
  • sudden, he cried, “Now, my hearty, luff!” And I put the helm hard up,
  • and the HISPANIOLA swung round rapidly and ran stem on for the low,
  • wooded shore.
  • The excitement of these last manoeuvres had somewhat interfered with the
  • watch I had kept hitherto, sharply enough, upon the coxswain. Even then
  • I was still so much interested, waiting for the ship to touch, that I
  • had quite forgot the peril that hung over my head and stood craning over
  • the starboard bulwarks and watching the ripples spreading wide before
  • the bows. I might have fallen without a struggle for my life had not a
  • sudden disquietude seized upon me and made me turn my head. Perhaps I
  • had heard a creak or seen his shadow moving with the tail of my eye;
  • perhaps it was an instinct like a cat's; but, sure enough, when I looked
  • round, there was Hands, already half-way towards me, with the dirk in
  • his right hand.
  • We must both have cried out aloud when our eyes met, but while mine
  • was the shrill cry of terror, his was a roar of fury like a charging
  • bully's. At the same instant, he threw himself forward and I leapt
  • sideways towards the bows. As I did so, I let go of the tiller, which
  • sprang sharp to leeward, and I think this saved my life, for it struck
  • Hands across the chest and stopped him, for the moment, dead.
  • Before he could recover, I was safe out of the corner where he had me
  • trapped, with all the deck to dodge about. Just forward of the main-mast
  • I stopped, drew a pistol from my pocket, took a cool aim, though he had
  • already turned and was once more coming directly after me, and drew the
  • trigger. The hammer fell, but there followed neither flash nor sound;
  • the priming was useless with sea-water. I cursed myself for my neglect.
  • Why had not I, long before, reprimed and reloaded my only weapons? Then
  • I should not have been as now, a mere fleeing sheep before this butcher.
  • Wounded as he was, it was wonderful how fast he could move, his grizzled
  • hair tumbling over his face, and his face itself as red as a red ensign
  • with his haste and fury. I had no time to try my other pistol, nor
  • indeed much inclination, for I was sure it would be useless. One thing I
  • saw plainly: I must not simply retreat before him, or he would speedily
  • hold me boxed into the bows, as a moment since he had so nearly boxed
  • me in the stern. Once so caught, and nine or ten inches of the
  • blood-stained dirk would be my last experience on this side of eternity.
  • I placed my palms against the main-mast, which was of a goodish bigness,
  • and waited, every nerve upon the stretch.
  • Seeing that I meant to dodge, he also paused; and a moment or two passed
  • in feints on his part and corresponding movements upon mine. It was such
  • a game as I had often played at home about the rocks of Black Hill Cove,
  • but never before, you may be sure, with such a wildly beating heart as
  • now. Still, as I say, it was a boy's game, and I thought I could hold
  • my own at it against an elderly seaman with a wounded thigh. Indeed my
  • courage had begun to rise so high that I allowed myself a few darting
  • thoughts on what would be the end of the affair, and while I saw
  • certainly that I could spin it out for long, I saw no hope of any
  • ultimate escape.
  • Well, while things stood thus, suddenly the HISPANIOLA struck,
  • staggered, ground for an instant in the sand, and then, swift as a
  • blow, canted over to the port side till the deck stood at an angle
  • of forty-five degrees and about a puncheon of water splashed into the
  • scupper holes and lay, in a pool, between the deck and bulwark.
  • We were both of us capsized in a second, and both of us rolled, almost
  • together, into the scuppers, the dead red-cap, with his arms still
  • spread out, tumbling stiffly after us. So near were we, indeed, that my
  • head came against the coxswain's foot with a crack that made my teeth
  • rattle. Blow and all, I was the first afoot again, for Hands had got
  • involved with the dead body. The sudden canting of the ship had made the
  • deck no place for running on; I had to find some new way of escape,
  • and that upon the instant, for my foe was almost touching me. Quick as
  • thought, I sprang into the mizzen shrouds, rattled up hand over hand,
  • and did not draw a breath till I was seated on the cross-trees.
  • I had been saved by being prompt; the dirk had struck not half a foot
  • below me as I pursued my upward flight; and there stood Israel Hands
  • with his mouth open and his face upturned to mine, a perfect statue of
  • surprise and disappointment.
  • Now that I had a moment to myself, I lost no time in changing the
  • priming of my pistol, and then, having one ready for service, and to
  • make assurance doubly sure, I proceeded to draw the load of the other
  • and recharge it afresh from the beginning.
  • My new employment struck Hands all of a heap; he began to see the dice
  • going against him, and after an obvious hesitation, he also hauled
  • himself heavily into the shrouds, and with the dirk in his teeth, began
  • slowly and painfully to mount. It cost him no end of time and groans
  • to haul his wounded leg behind him, and I had quietly finished my
  • arrangements before he was much more than a third of the way up. Then,
  • with a pistol in either hand, I addressed him.
  • “One more step, Mr. Hands,” said I, “and I'll blow your brains out! Dead
  • men don't bite, you know,” I added with a chuckle.
  • He stopped instantly. I could see by the working of his face that he was
  • trying to think, and the process was so slow and laborious that, in my
  • new-found security, I laughed aloud. At last, with a swallow or two, he
  • spoke, his face still wearing the same expression of extreme perplexity.
  • In order to speak he had to take the dagger from his mouth, but in all
  • else he remained unmoved.
  • “Jim,” says he, “I reckon we're fouled, you and me, and we'll have to
  • sign articles. I'd have had you but for that there lurch, but I don't
  • have no luck, not I; and I reckon I'll have to strike, which comes hard,
  • you see, for a master mariner to a ship's younker like you, Jim.”
  • I was drinking in his words and smiling away, as conceited as a cock
  • upon a wall, when, all in a breath, back went his right hand over his
  • shoulder. Something sang like an arrow through the air; I felt a blow
  • and then a sharp pang, and there I was pinned by the shoulder to the
  • mast. In the horrid pain and surprise of the moment--I scarce can say
  • it was by my own volition, and I am sure it was without a conscious
  • aim--both my pistols went off, and both escaped out of my hands. They
  • did not fall alone; with a choked cry, the coxswain loosed his grasp
  • upon the shrouds and plunged head first into the water.
  • 27
  • “Pieces of Eight”
  • OWING to the cant of the vessel, the masts hung far out over the water,
  • and from my perch on the cross-trees I had nothing below me but the
  • surface of the bay. Hands, who was not so far up, was in consequence
  • nearer to the ship and fell between me and the bulwarks. He rose once to
  • the surface in a lather of foam and blood and then sank again for good.
  • As the water settled, I could see him lying huddled together on the
  • clean, bright sand in the shadow of the vessel's sides. A fish or two
  • whipped past his body. Sometimes, by the quivering of the water, he
  • appeared to move a little, as if he were trying to rise. But he was dead
  • enough, for all that, being both shot and drowned, and was food for fish
  • in the very place where he had designed my slaughter.
  • I was no sooner certain of this than I began to feel sick, faint, and
  • terrified. The hot blood was running over my back and chest. The dirk,
  • where it had pinned my shoulder to the mast, seemed to burn like a hot
  • iron; yet it was not so much these real sufferings that distressed me,
  • for these, it seemed to me, I could bear without a murmur; it was the
  • horror I had upon my mind of falling from the cross-trees into that
  • still green water, beside the body of the coxswain.
  • I clung with both hands till my nails ached, and I shut my eyes as if to
  • cover up the peril. Gradually my mind came back again, my pulses quieted
  • down to a more natural time, and I was once more in possession of
  • myself.
  • It was my first thought to pluck forth the dirk, but either it stuck too
  • hard or my nerve failed me, and I desisted with a violent shudder. Oddly
  • enough, that very shudder did the business. The knife, in fact, had come
  • the nearest in the world to missing me altogether; it held me by a mere
  • pinch of skin, and this the shudder tore away. The blood ran down the
  • faster, to be sure, but I was my own master again and only tacked to the
  • mast by my coat and shirt.
  • These last I broke through with a sudden jerk, and then regained the
  • deck by the starboard shrouds. For nothing in the world would I have
  • again ventured, shaken as I was, upon the overhanging port shrouds from
  • which Israel had so lately fallen.
  • I went below and did what I could for my wound; it pained me a good deal
  • and still bled freely, but it was neither deep nor dangerous, nor did it
  • greatly gall me when I used my arm. Then I looked around me, and as the
  • ship was now, in a sense, my own, I began to think of clearing it from
  • its last passenger--the dead man, O'Brien.
  • He had pitched, as I have said, against the bulwarks, where he lay
  • like some horrible, ungainly sort of puppet, life-size, indeed, but how
  • different from life's colour or life's comeliness! In that position
  • I could easily have my way with him, and as the habit of tragical
  • adventures had worn off almost all my terror for the dead, I took him
  • by the waist as if he had been a sack of bran and with one good heave,
  • tumbled him overboard. He went in with a sounding plunge; the red cap
  • came off and remained floating on the surface; and as soon as the splash
  • subsided, I could see him and Israel lying side by side, both wavering
  • with the tremulous movement of the water. O'Brien, though still quite a
  • young man, was very bald. There he lay, with that bald head across the
  • knees of the man who had killed him and the quick fishes steering to and
  • fro over both.
  • I was now alone upon the ship; the tide had just turned. The sun was
  • within so few degrees of setting that already the shadow of the pines
  • upon the western shore began to reach right across the anchorage and
  • fall in patterns on the deck. The evening breeze had sprung up, and
  • though it was well warded off by the hill with the two peaks upon the
  • east, the cordage had begun to sing a little softly to itself and the
  • idle sails to rattle to and fro.
  • I began to see a danger to the ship. The jibs I speedily doused and
  • brought tumbling to the deck, but the main-sail was a harder matter. Of
  • course, when the schooner canted over, the boom had swung out-board, and
  • the cap of it and a foot or two of sail hung even under water. I thought
  • this made it still more dangerous; yet the strain was so heavy that I
  • half feared to meddle. At last I got my knife and cut the halyards. The
  • peak dropped instantly, a great belly of loose canvas floated broad upon
  • the water, and since, pull as I liked, I could not budge the downhall,
  • that was the extent of what I could accomplish. For the rest, the
  • HISPANIOLA must trust to luck, like myself.
  • By this time the whole anchorage had fallen into shadow--the last rays,
  • I remember, falling through a glade of the wood and shining bright as
  • jewels on the flowery mantle of the wreck. It began to be chill; the
  • tide was rapidly fleeting seaward, the schooner settling more and more
  • on her beam-ends.
  • I scrambled forward and looked over. It seemed shallow enough, and
  • holding the cut hawser in both hands for a last security, I let myself
  • drop softly overboard. The water scarcely reached my waist; the sand was
  • firm and covered with ripple marks, and I waded ashore in great spirits,
  • leaving the HISPANIOLA on her side, with her main-sail trailing wide
  • upon the surface of the bay. About the same time, the sun went fairly
  • down and the breeze whistled low in the dusk among the tossing pines.
  • At least, and at last, I was off the sea, nor had I returned thence
  • empty-handed. There lay the schooner, clear at last from buccaneers
  • and ready for our own men to board and get to sea again. I had nothing
  • nearer my fancy than to get home to the stockade and boast of my
  • achievements. Possibly I might be blamed a bit for my truantry, but the
  • recapture of the HISPANIOLA was a clenching answer, and I hoped that
  • even Captain Smollett would confess I had not lost my time.
  • So thinking, and in famous spirits, I began to set my face homeward for
  • the block house and my companions. I remembered that the most easterly
  • of the rivers which drain into Captain Kidd's anchorage ran from the
  • two-peaked hill upon my left, and I bent my course in that direction
  • that I might pass the stream while it was small. The wood was pretty
  • open, and keeping along the lower spurs, I had soon turned the corner
  • of that hill, and not long after waded to the mid-calf across the
  • watercourse.
  • This brought me near to where I had encountered Ben Gunn, the maroon;
  • and I walked more circumspectly, keeping an eye on every side. The dusk
  • had come nigh hand completely, and as I opened out the cleft between the
  • two peaks, I became aware of a wavering glow against the sky, where, as
  • I judged, the man of the island was cooking his supper before a roaring
  • fire. And yet I wondered, in my heart, that he should show himself so
  • careless. For if I could see this radiance, might it not reach the eyes
  • of Silver himself where he camped upon the shore among the marshes?
  • Gradually the night fell blacker; it was all I could do to guide myself
  • even roughly towards my destination; the double hill behind me and the
  • Spy-glass on my right hand loomed faint and fainter; the stars were few
  • and pale; and in the low ground where I wandered I kept tripping among
  • bushes and rolling into sandy pits.
  • Suddenly a kind of brightness fell about me. I looked up; a pale glimmer
  • of moonbeams had alighted on the summit of the Spy-glass, and soon after
  • I saw something broad and silvery moving low down behind the trees, and
  • knew the moon had risen.
  • With this to help me, I passed rapidly over what remained to me of my
  • journey, and sometimes walking, sometimes running, impatiently drew near
  • to the stockade. Yet, as I began to thread the grove that lies before
  • it, I was not so thoughtless but that I slacked my pace and went a
  • trifle warily. It would have been a poor end of my adventures to get
  • shot down by my own party in mistake.
  • The moon was climbing higher and higher, its light began to fall here
  • and there in masses through the more open districts of the wood, and
  • right in front of me a glow of a different colour appeared among
  • the trees. It was red and hot, and now and again it was a little
  • darkened--as it were, the embers of a bonfire smouldering.
  • For the life of me I could not think what it might be.
  • At last I came right down upon the borders of the clearing. The western
  • end was already steeped in moonshine; the rest, and the block house
  • itself, still lay in a black shadow chequered with long silvery streaks
  • of light. On the other side of the house an immense fire had burned
  • itself into clear embers and shed a steady, red reverberation,
  • contrasted strongly with the mellow paleness of the moon. There was not
  • a soul stirring nor a sound beside the noises of the breeze.
  • I stopped, with much wonder in my heart, and perhaps a little terror
  • also. It had not been our way to build great fires; we were, indeed,
  • by the captain's orders, somewhat niggardly of firewood, and I began to
  • fear that something had gone wrong while I was absent.
  • I stole round by the eastern end, keeping close in shadow, and at a
  • convenient place, where the darkness was thickest, crossed the palisade.
  • To make assurance surer, I got upon my hands and knees and crawled,
  • without a sound, towards the corner of the house. As I drew nearer, my
  • heart was suddenly and greatly lightened. It is not a pleasant noise in
  • itself, and I have often complained of it at other times, but just
  • then it was like music to hear my friends snoring together so loud and
  • peaceful in their sleep. The sea-cry of the watch, that beautiful “All's
  • well,” never fell more reassuringly on my ear.
  • In the meantime, there was no doubt of one thing; they kept an infamous
  • bad watch. If it had been Silver and his lads that were now creeping
  • in on them, not a soul would have seen daybreak. That was what it
  • was, thought I, to have the captain wounded; and again I blamed myself
  • sharply for leaving them in that danger with so few to mount guard.
  • By this time I had got to the door and stood up. All was dark within,
  • so that I could distinguish nothing by the eye. As for sounds, there
  • was the steady drone of the snorers and a small occasional noise, a
  • flickering or pecking that I could in no way account for.
  • With my arms before me I walked steadily in. I should lie down in my own
  • place (I thought with a silent chuckle) and enjoy their faces when they
  • found me in the morning.
  • My foot struck something yielding--it was a sleeper's leg; and he turned
  • and groaned, but without awaking.
  • And then, all of a sudden, a shrill voice broke forth out of the
  • darkness:
  • “Pieces of eight! Pieces of eight! Pieces of eight! Pieces of eight!
  • Pieces of eight!” and so forth, without pause or change, like the
  • clacking of a tiny mill.
  • Silver's green parrot, Captain Flint! It was she whom I had heard
  • pecking at a piece of bark; it was she, keeping better watch than any
  • human being, who thus announced my arrival with her wearisome refrain.
  • I had no time left me to recover. At the sharp, clipping tone of the
  • parrot, the sleepers awoke and sprang up; and with a mighty oath, the
  • voice of Silver cried, “Who goes?”
  • I turned to run, struck violently against one person, recoiled, and ran
  • full into the arms of a second, who for his part closed upon and held me
  • tight.
  • “Bring a torch, Dick,” said Silver when my capture was thus assured.
  • And one of the men left the log-house and presently returned with a
  • lighted brand.
  • PART SIX--Captain Silver
  • 28
  • In the Enemy's Camp
  • THE red glare of the torch, lighting up the interior of the block house,
  • showed me the worst of my apprehensions realized. The pirates were in
  • possession of the house and stores: there was the cask of cognac,
  • there were the pork and bread, as before, and what tenfold increased
  • my horror, not a sign of any prisoner. I could only judge that all had
  • perished, and my heart smote me sorely that I had not been there to
  • perish with them.
  • There were six of the buccaneers, all told; not another man was left
  • alive. Five of them were on their feet, flushed and swollen, suddenly
  • called out of the first sleep of drunkenness. The sixth had only risen
  • upon his elbow; he was deadly pale, and the blood-stained bandage round
  • his head told that he had recently been wounded, and still more recently
  • dressed. I remembered the man who had been shot and had run back among
  • the woods in the great attack, and doubted not that this was he.
  • The parrot sat, preening her plumage, on Long John's shoulder. He
  • himself, I thought, looked somewhat paler and more stern than I was used
  • to. He still wore the fine broadcloth suit in which he had fulfilled his
  • mission, but it was bitterly the worse for wear, daubed with clay and
  • torn with the sharp briers of the wood.
  • “So,” said he, “here's Jim Hawkins, shiver my timbers! Dropped in, like,
  • eh? Well, come, I take that friendly.”
  • And thereupon he sat down across the brandy cask and began to fill a
  • pipe.
  • “Give me a loan of the link, Dick,” said he; and then, when he had a
  • good light, “That'll do, lad,” he added; “stick the glim in the wood
  • heap; and you, gentlemen, bring yourselves to! You needn't stand up
  • for Mr. Hawkins; HE'LL excuse you, you may lay to that. And so,
  • Jim”--stopping the tobacco--“here you were, and quite a pleasant
  • surprise for poor old John. I see you were smart when first I set my
  • eyes on you, but this here gets away from me clean, it do.”
  • To all this, as may be well supposed, I made no answer. They had set me
  • with my back against the wall, and I stood there, looking Silver in the
  • face, pluckily enough, I hope, to all outward appearance, but with black
  • despair in my heart.
  • Silver took a whiff or two of his pipe with great composure and then ran
  • on again.
  • “Now, you see, Jim, so be as you ARE here,” says he, “I'll give you a
  • piece of my mind. I've always liked you, I have, for a lad of spirit,
  • and the picter of my own self when I was young and handsome. I always
  • wanted you to jine and take your share, and die a gentleman, and now, my
  • cock, you've got to. Cap'n Smollett's a fine seaman, as I'll own up to
  • any day, but stiff on discipline. 'Dooty is dooty,' says he, and right
  • he is. Just you keep clear of the cap'n. The doctor himself is gone dead
  • again you--'ungrateful scamp' was what he said; and the short and the
  • long of the whole story is about here: you can't go back to your own
  • lot, for they won't have you; and without you start a third ship's
  • company all by yourself, which might be lonely, you'll have to jine with
  • Cap'n Silver.”
  • So far so good. My friends, then, were still alive, and though I partly
  • believed the truth of Silver's statement, that the cabin party were
  • incensed at me for my desertion, I was more relieved than distressed by
  • what I heard.
  • “I don't say nothing as to your being in our hands,” continued Silver,
  • “though there you are, and you may lay to it. I'm all for argyment; I
  • never seen good come out o' threatening. If you like the service, well,
  • you'll jine; and if you don't, Jim, why, you're free to answer no--free
  • and welcome, shipmate; and if fairer can be said by mortal seaman,
  • shiver my sides!”
  • “Am I to answer, then?” I asked with a very tremulous voice. Through all
  • this sneering talk, I was made to feel the threat of death that overhung
  • me, and my cheeks burned and my heart beat painfully in my breast.
  • “Lad,” said Silver, “no one's a-pressing of you. Take your bearings.
  • None of us won't hurry you, mate; time goes so pleasant in your company,
  • you see.”
  • “Well,” says I, growing a bit bolder, “if I'm to choose, I declare I
  • have a right to know what's what, and why you're here, and where my
  • friends are.”
  • “Wot's wot?” repeated one of the buccaneers in a deep growl. “Ah, he'd
  • be a lucky one as knowed that!”
  • “You'll perhaps batten down your hatches till you're spoke to, my
  • friend,” cried Silver truculently to this speaker. And then, in
  • his first gracious tones, he replied to me, “Yesterday morning, Mr.
  • Hawkins,” said he, “in the dog-watch, down came Doctor Livesey with a
  • flag of truce. Says he, 'Cap'n Silver, you're sold out. Ship's gone.'
  • Well, maybe we'd been taking a glass, and a song to help it round. I
  • won't say no. Leastways, none of us had looked out. We looked out, and
  • by thunder, the old ship was gone! I never seen a pack o' fools look
  • fishier; and you may lay to that, if I tells you that looked the
  • fishiest. 'Well,' says the doctor, 'let's bargain.' We bargained, him
  • and I, and here we are: stores, brandy, block house, the firewood you
  • was thoughtful enough to cut, and in a manner of speaking, the whole
  • blessed boat, from cross-trees to kelson. As for them, they've tramped;
  • I don't know where's they are.”
  • He drew again quietly at his pipe.
  • “And lest you should take it into that head of yours,” he went on, “that
  • you was included in the treaty, here's the last word that was said: 'How
  • many are you,' says I, 'to leave?' 'Four,' says he; 'four, and one of us
  • wounded. As for that boy, I don't know where he is, confound him,' says
  • he, 'nor I don't much care. We're about sick of him.' These was his
  • words.
  • “Is that all?” I asked.
  • “Well, it's all that you're to hear, my son,” returned Silver.
  • “And now I am to choose?”
  • “And now you are to choose, and you may lay to that,” said Silver.
  • “Well,” said I, “I am not such a fool but I know pretty well what I have
  • to look for. Let the worst come to the worst, it's little I care. I've
  • seen too many die since I fell in with you. But there's a thing or two
  • I have to tell you,” I said, and by this time I was quite excited; “and
  • the first is this: here you are, in a bad way--ship lost, treasure lost,
  • men lost, your whole business gone to wreck; and if you want to know who
  • did it--it was I! I was in the apple barrel the night we sighted land,
  • and I heard you, John, and you, Dick Johnson, and Hands, who is now at
  • the bottom of the sea, and told every word you said before the hour was
  • out. And as for the schooner, it was I who cut her cable, and it was I
  • that killed the men you had aboard of her, and it was I who brought her
  • where you'll never see her more, not one of you. The laugh's on my side;
  • I've had the top of this business from the first; I no more fear you
  • than I fear a fly. Kill me, if you please, or spare me. But one thing
  • I'll say, and no more; if you spare me, bygones are bygones, and when
  • you fellows are in court for piracy, I'll save you all I can. It is for
  • you to choose. Kill another and do yourselves no good, or spare me and
  • keep a witness to save you from the gallows.”
  • I stopped, for, I tell you, I was out of breath, and to my wonder, not
  • a man of them moved, but all sat staring at me like as many sheep. And
  • while they were still staring, I broke out again, “And now, Mr. Silver,”
  • I said, “I believe you're the best man here, and if things go to the
  • worst, I'll take it kind of you to let the doctor know the way I took
  • it.”
  • “I'll bear it in mind,” said Silver with an accent so curious that I
  • could not, for the life of me, decide whether he were laughing at my
  • request or had been favourably affected by my courage.
  • “I'll put one to that,” cried the old mahogany-faced seaman--Morgan
  • by name--whom I had seen in Long John's public-house upon the quays of
  • Bristol. “It was him that knowed Black Dog.”
  • “Well, and see here,” added the sea-cook. “I'll put another again to
  • that, by thunder! For it was this same boy that faked the chart from
  • Billy Bones. First and last, we've split upon Jim Hawkins!”
  • “Then here goes!” said Morgan with an oath.
  • And he sprang up, drawing his knife as if he had been twenty.
  • “Avast, there!” cried Silver. “Who are you, Tom Morgan? Maybe you
  • thought you was cap'n here, perhaps. By the powers, but I'll teach you
  • better! Cross me, and you'll go where many a good man's gone before you,
  • first and last, these thirty year back--some to the yard-arm, shiver
  • my timbers, and some by the board, and all to feed the fishes. There's
  • never a man looked me between the eyes and seen a good day a'terwards,
  • Tom Morgan, you may lay to that.”
  • Morgan paused, but a hoarse murmur rose from the others.
  • “Tom's right,” said one.
  • “I stood hazing long enough from one,” added another. “I'll be hanged if
  • I'll be hazed by you, John Silver.”
  • “Did any of you gentlemen want to have it out with ME?” roared Silver,
  • bending far forward from his position on the keg, with his pipe still
  • glowing in his right hand. “Put a name on what you're at; you ain't
  • dumb, I reckon. Him that wants shall get it. Have I lived this many
  • years, and a son of a rum puncheon cock his hat athwart my hawse at the
  • latter end of it? You know the way; you're all gentlemen o' fortune, by
  • your account. Well, I'm ready. Take a cutlass, him that dares, and I'll
  • see the colour of his inside, crutch and all, before that pipe's empty.”
  • Not a man stirred; not a man answered.
  • “That's your sort, is it?” he added, returning his pipe to his mouth.
  • “Well, you're a gay lot to look at, anyway. Not much worth to fight, you
  • ain't. P'r'aps you can understand King George's English. I'm cap'n here
  • by 'lection. I'm cap'n here because I'm the best man by a long sea-mile.
  • You won't fight, as gentlemen o' fortune should; then, by thunder,
  • you'll obey, and you may lay to it! I like that boy, now; I never seen
  • a better boy than that. He's more a man than any pair of rats of you in
  • this here house, and what I say is this: let me see him that'll lay a
  • hand on him--that's what I say, and you may lay to it.”
  • There was a long pause after this. I stood straight up against the wall,
  • my heart still going like a sledge-hammer, but with a ray of hope
  • now shining in my bosom. Silver leant back against the wall, his arms
  • crossed, his pipe in the corner of his mouth, as calm as though he had
  • been in church; yet his eye kept wandering furtively, and he kept the
  • tail of it on his unruly followers. They, on their part, drew gradually
  • together towards the far end of the block house, and the low hiss of
  • their whispering sounded in my ear continuously, like a stream. One
  • after another, they would look up, and the red light of the torch would
  • fall for a second on their nervous faces; but it was not towards me, it
  • was towards Silver that they turned their eyes.
  • “You seem to have a lot to say,” remarked Silver, spitting far into the
  • air. “Pipe up and let me hear it, or lay to.”
  • “Ax your pardon, sir,” returned one of the men; “you're pretty free with
  • some of the rules; maybe you'll kindly keep an eye upon the rest. This
  • crew's dissatisfied; this crew don't vally bullying a marlin-spike; this
  • crew has its rights like other crews, I'll make so free as that; and by
  • your own rules, I take it we can talk together. I ax your pardon, sir,
  • acknowledging you for to be captaing at this present; but I claim my
  • right, and steps outside for a council.”
  • And with an elaborate sea-salute, this fellow, a long, ill-looking,
  • yellow-eyed man of five and thirty, stepped coolly towards the door and
  • disappeared out of the house. One after another the rest followed his
  • example, each making a salute as he passed, each adding some apology.
  • “According to rules,” said one. “Forecastle council,” said Morgan. And
  • so with one remark or another all marched out and left Silver and me
  • alone with the torch.
  • The sea-cook instantly removed his pipe.
  • “Now, look you here, Jim Hawkins,” he said in a steady whisper that was
  • no more than audible, “you're within half a plank of death, and what's
  • a long sight worse, of torture. They're going to throw me off. But, you
  • mark, I stand by you through thick and thin. I didn't mean to; no, not
  • till you spoke up. I was about desperate to lose that much blunt, and
  • be hanged into the bargain. But I see you was the right sort. I says to
  • myself, you stand by Hawkins, John, and Hawkins'll stand by you. You're
  • his last card, and by the living thunder, John, he's yours! Back to
  • back, says I. You save your witness, and he'll save your neck!”
  • I began dimly to understand.
  • “You mean all's lost?” I asked.
  • “Aye, by gum, I do!” he answered. “Ship gone, neck gone--that's the
  • size of it. Once I looked into that bay, Jim Hawkins, and seen no
  • schooner--well, I'm tough, but I gave out. As for that lot and their
  • council, mark me, they're outright fools and cowards. I'll save your
  • life--if so be as I can--from them. But, see here, Jim--tit for tat--you
  • save Long John from swinging.”
  • I was bewildered; it seemed a thing so hopeless he was asking--he, the
  • old buccaneer, the ringleader throughout.
  • “What I can do, that I'll do,” I said.
  • “It's a bargain!” cried Long John. “You speak up plucky, and by thunder,
  • I've a chance!”
  • He hobbled to the torch, where it stood propped among the firewood, and
  • took a fresh light to his pipe.
  • “Understand me, Jim,” he said, returning. “I've a head on my shoulders,
  • I have. I'm on squire's side now. I know you've got that ship safe
  • somewheres. How you done it, I don't know, but safe it is. I guess Hands
  • and O'Brien turned soft. I never much believed in neither of THEM. Now
  • you mark me. I ask no questions, nor I won't let others. I know when
  • a game's up, I do; and I know a lad that's staunch. Ah, you that's
  • young--you and me might have done a power of good together!”
  • He drew some cognac from the cask into a tin cannikin.
  • “Will you taste, messmate?” he asked; and when I had refused: “Well,
  • I'll take a dram myself, Jim,” said he. “I need a caulker, for there's
  • trouble on hand. And talking o' trouble, why did that doctor give me the
  • chart, Jim?”
  • My face expressed a wonder so unaffected that he saw the needlessness of
  • further questions.
  • “Ah, well, he did, though,” said he. “And there's something under that,
  • no doubt--something, surely, under that, Jim--bad or good.”
  • And he took another swallow of the brandy, shaking his great fair head
  • like a man who looks forward to the worst.
  • 29
  • The Black Spot Again
  • THE council of buccaneers had lasted some time, when one of them
  • re-entered the house, and with a repetition of the same salute, which
  • had in my eyes an ironical air, begged for a moment's loan of the torch.
  • Silver briefly agreed, and this emissary retired again, leaving us
  • together in the dark.
  • “There's a breeze coming, Jim,” said Silver, who had by this time
  • adopted quite a friendly and familiar tone.
  • I turned to the loophole nearest me and looked out. The embers of the
  • great fire had so far burned themselves out and now glowed so low and
  • duskily that I understood why these conspirators desired a torch. About
  • half-way down the slope to the stockade, they were collected in a group;
  • one held the light, another was on his knees in their midst, and I saw
  • the blade of an open knife shine in his hand with varying colours in
  • the moon and torchlight. The rest were all somewhat stooping, as though
  • watching the manoeuvres of this last. I could just make out that he
  • had a book as well as a knife in his hand, and was still wondering how
  • anything so incongruous had come in their possession when the kneeling
  • figure rose once more to his feet and the whole party began to move
  • together towards the house.
  • “Here they come,” said I; and I returned to my former position, for it
  • seemed beneath my dignity that they should find me watching them.
  • “Well, let 'em come, lad--let 'em come,” said Silver cheerily. “I've
  • still a shot in my locker.”
  • The door opened, and the five men, standing huddled together just
  • inside, pushed one of their number forward. In any other circumstances
  • it would have been comical to see his slow advance, hesitating as he set
  • down each foot, but holding his closed right hand in front of him.
  • “Step up, lad,” cried Silver. “I won't eat you. Hand it over, lubber. I
  • know the rules, I do; I won't hurt a depytation.”
  • Thus encouraged, the buccaneer stepped forth more briskly, and having
  • passed something to Silver, from hand to hand, slipped yet more smartly
  • back again to his companions.
  • The sea-cook looked at what had been given him.
  • “The black spot! I thought so,” he observed. “Where might you have got
  • the paper? Why, hillo! Look here, now; this ain't lucky! You've gone and
  • cut this out of a Bible. What fool's cut a Bible?”
  • “Ah, there!” said Morgan. “There! Wot did I say? No good'll come o'
  • that, I said.”
  • “Well, you've about fixed it now, among you,” continued Silver. “You'll
  • all swing now, I reckon. What soft-headed lubber had a Bible?”
  • “It was Dick,” said one.
  • “Dick, was it? Then Dick can get to prayers,” said Silver. “He's seen
  • his slice of luck, has Dick, and you may lay to that.”
  • But here the long man with the yellow eyes struck in.
  • “Belay that talk, John Silver,” he said. “This crew has tipped you the
  • black spot in full council, as in dooty bound; just you turn it over, as
  • in dooty bound, and see what's wrote there. Then you can talk.”
  • “Thanky, George,” replied the sea-cook. “You always was brisk for
  • business, and has the rules by heart, George, as I'm pleased to see.
  • Well, what is it, anyway? Ah! 'Deposed'--that's it, is it? Very pretty
  • wrote, to be sure; like print, I swear. Your hand o' write, George? Why,
  • you was gettin' quite a leadin' man in this here crew. You'll be cap'n
  • next, I shouldn't wonder. Just oblige me with that torch again, will
  • you? This pipe don't draw.”
  • “Come, now,” said George, “you don't fool this crew no more. You're a
  • funny man, by your account; but you're over now, and you'll maybe step
  • down off that barrel and help vote.”
  • “I thought you said you knowed the rules,” returned Silver
  • contemptuously. “Leastways, if you don't, I do; and I wait here--and I'm
  • still your cap'n, mind--till you outs with your grievances and I reply;
  • in the meantime, your black spot ain't worth a biscuit. After that,
  • we'll see.”
  • “Oh,” replied George, “you don't be under no kind of apprehension; WE'RE
  • all square, we are. First, you've made a hash of this cruise--you'll be
  • a bold man to say no to that. Second, you let the enemy out o' this here
  • trap for nothing. Why did they want out? I dunno, but it's pretty plain
  • they wanted it. Third, you wouldn't let us go at them upon the march.
  • Oh, we see through you, John Silver; you want to play booty, that's
  • what's wrong with you. And then, fourth, there's this here boy.”
  • “Is that all?” asked Silver quietly.
  • “Enough, too,” retorted George. “We'll all swing and sun-dry for your
  • bungling.”
  • “Well now, look here, I'll answer these four p'ints; one after another
  • I'll answer 'em. I made a hash o' this cruise, did I? Well now, you all
  • know what I wanted, and you all know if that had been done that we'd
  • 'a been aboard the HISPANIOLA this night as ever was, every man of us
  • alive, and fit, and full of good plum-duff, and the treasure in the hold
  • of her, by thunder! Well, who crossed me? Who forced my hand, as was the
  • lawful cap'n? Who tipped me the black spot the day we landed and began
  • this dance? Ah, it's a fine dance--I'm with you there--and looks mighty
  • like a hornpipe in a rope's end at Execution Dock by London town, it
  • does. But who done it? Why, it was Anderson, and Hands, and you, George
  • Merry! And you're the last above board of that same meddling crew;
  • and you have the Davy Jones's insolence to up and stand for cap'n over
  • me--you, that sank the lot of us! By the powers! But this tops the
  • stiffest yarn to nothing.”
  • Silver paused, and I could see by the faces of George and his late
  • comrades that these words had not been said in vain.
  • “That's for number one,” cried the accused, wiping the sweat from his
  • brow, for he had been talking with a vehemence that shook the house.
  • “Why, I give you my word, I'm sick to speak to you. You've neither sense
  • nor memory, and I leave it to fancy where your mothers was that let you
  • come to sea. Sea! Gentlemen o' fortune! I reckon tailors is your trade.”
  • “Go on, John,” said Morgan. “Speak up to the others.”
  • “Ah, the others!” returned John. “They're a nice lot, ain't they? You
  • say this cruise is bungled. Ah! By gum, if you could understand how bad
  • it's bungled, you would see! We're that near the gibbet that my neck's
  • stiff with thinking on it. You've seen 'em, maybe, hanged in chains,
  • birds about 'em, seamen p'inting 'em out as they go down with the tide.
  • 'Who's that?' says one. 'That! Why, that's John Silver. I knowed him
  • well,' says another. And you can hear the chains a-jangle as you go
  • about and reach for the other buoy. Now, that's about where we are,
  • every mother's son of us, thanks to him, and Hands, and Anderson, and
  • other ruination fools of you. And if you want to know about number four,
  • and that boy, why, shiver my timbers, isn't he a hostage? Are we a-going
  • to waste a hostage? No, not us; he might be our last chance, and I
  • shouldn't wonder. Kill that boy? Not me, mates! And number three? Ah,
  • well, there's a deal to say to number three. Maybe you don't count it
  • nothing to have a real college doctor to see you every day--you, John,
  • with your head broke--or you, George Merry, that had the ague shakes
  • upon you not six hours agone, and has your eyes the colour of lemon peel
  • to this same moment on the clock? And maybe, perhaps, you didn't know
  • there was a consort coming either? But there is, and not so long till
  • then; and we'll see who'll be glad to have a hostage when it comes to
  • that. And as for number two, and why I made a bargain--well, you came
  • crawling on your knees to me to make it--on your knees you came, you was
  • that downhearted--and you'd have starved too if I hadn't--but that's a
  • trifle! You look there--that's why!”
  • And he cast down upon the floor a paper that I instantly
  • recognized--none other than the chart on yellow paper, with the three
  • red crosses, that I had found in the oilcloth at the bottom of the
  • captain's chest. Why the doctor had given it to him was more than I
  • could fancy.
  • But if it were inexplicable to me, the appearance of the chart was
  • incredible to the surviving mutineers. They leaped upon it like cats
  • upon a mouse. It went from hand to hand, one tearing it from another;
  • and by the oaths and the cries and the childish laughter with which they
  • accompanied their examination, you would have thought, not only they
  • were fingering the very gold, but were at sea with it, besides, in
  • safety.
  • “Yes,” said one, “that's Flint, sure enough. J. F., and a score below,
  • with a clove hitch to it; so he done ever.”
  • “Mighty pretty,” said George. “But how are we to get away with it, and
  • us no ship.”
  • Silver suddenly sprang up, and supporting himself with a hand against
  • the wall: “Now I give you warning, George,” he cried. “One more word
  • of your sauce, and I'll call you down and fight you. How? Why, how do I
  • know? You had ought to tell me that--you and the rest, that lost me my
  • schooner, with your interference, burn you! But not you, you can't; you
  • hain't got the invention of a cockroach. But civil you can speak, and
  • shall, George Merry, you may lay to that.”
  • “That's fair enow,” said the old man Morgan.
  • “Fair! I reckon so,” said the sea-cook. “You lost the ship; I found the
  • treasure. Who's the better man at that? And now I resign, by thunder!
  • Elect whom you please to be your cap'n now; I'm done with it.”
  • “Silver!” they cried. “Barbecue forever! Barbecue for cap'n!”
  • “So that's the toon, is it?” cried the cook. “George, I reckon you'll
  • have to wait another turn, friend; and lucky for you as I'm not a
  • revengeful man. But that was never my way. And now, shipmates, this
  • black spot? 'Tain't much good now, is it? Dick's crossed his luck and
  • spoiled his Bible, and that's about all.”
  • “It'll do to kiss the book on still, won't it?” growled Dick, who was
  • evidently uneasy at the curse he had brought upon himself.
  • “A Bible with a bit cut out!” returned Silver derisively. “Not it. It
  • don't bind no more'n a ballad-book.”
  • “Don't it, though?” cried Dick with a sort of joy. “Well, I reckon
  • that's worth having too.”
  • “Here, Jim--here's a cur'osity for you,” said Silver, and he tossed me
  • the paper.
  • It was around about the size of a crown piece. One side was blank,
  • for it had been the last leaf; the other contained a verse or two of
  • Revelation--these words among the rest, which struck sharply home upon
  • my mind: “Without are dogs and murderers.” The printed side had been
  • blackened with wood ash, which already began to come off and soil my
  • fingers; on the blank side had been written with the same material the
  • one word “Depposed.” I have that curiosity beside me at this moment, but
  • not a trace of writing now remains beyond a single scratch, such as a
  • man might make with his thumb-nail.
  • That was the end of the night's business. Soon after, with a drink all
  • round, we lay down to sleep, and the outside of Silver's vengeance was
  • to put George Merry up for sentinel and threaten him with death if he
  • should prove unfaithful.
  • It was long ere I could close an eye, and heaven knows I had matter
  • enough for thought in the man whom I had slain that afternoon, in my own
  • most perilous position, and above all, in the remarkable game that I saw
  • Silver now engaged upon--keeping the mutineers together with one hand
  • and grasping with the other after every means, possible and impossible,
  • to make his peace and save his miserable life. He himself slept
  • peacefully and snored aloud, yet my heart was sore for him, wicked as he
  • was, to think on the dark perils that environed and the shameful gibbet
  • that awaited him.
  • 30
  • On Parole
  • I WAS wakened--indeed, we were all wakened, for I could see even the
  • sentinel shake himself together from where he had fallen against the
  • door-post--by a clear, hearty voice hailing us from the margin of the
  • wood:
  • “Block house, ahoy!” it cried. “Here's the doctor.”
  • And the doctor it was. Although I was glad to hear the sound, yet my
  • gladness was not without admixture. I remembered with confusion my
  • insubordinate and stealthy conduct, and when I saw where it had brought
  • me--among what companions and surrounded by what dangers--I felt ashamed
  • to look him in the face.
  • He must have risen in the dark, for the day had hardly come; and when I
  • ran to a loophole and looked out, I saw him standing, like Silver once
  • before, up to the mid-leg in creeping vapour.
  • “You, doctor! Top o' the morning to you, sir!” cried Silver, broad awake
  • and beaming with good nature in a moment. “Bright and early, to be sure;
  • and it's the early bird, as the saying goes, that gets the rations.
  • George, shake up your timbers, son, and help Dr. Livesey over the ship's
  • side. All a-doin' well, your patients was--all well and merry.”
  • So he pattered on, standing on the hilltop with his crutch under his
  • elbow and one hand upon the side of the log-house--quite the old John in
  • voice, manner, and expression.
  • “We've quite a surprise for you too, sir,” he continued. “We've a little
  • stranger here--he! he! A noo boarder and lodger, sir, and looking fit
  • and taut as a fiddle; slep' like a supercargo, he did, right alongside
  • of John--stem to stem we was, all night.”
  • Dr. Livesey was by this time across the stockade and pretty near the
  • cook, and I could hear the alteration in his voice as he said, “Not
  • Jim?”
  • “The very same Jim as ever was,” says Silver.
  • The doctor stopped outright, although he did not speak, and it was some
  • seconds before he seemed able to move on.
  • “Well, well,” he said at last, “duty first and pleasure afterwards, as
  • you might have said yourself, Silver. Let us overhaul these patients of
  • yours.”
  • A moment afterwards he had entered the block house and with one grim
  • nod to me proceeded with his work among the sick. He seemed under no
  • apprehension, though he must have known that his life, among these
  • treacherous demons, depended on a hair; and he rattled on to his
  • patients as if he were paying an ordinary professional visit in a quiet
  • English family. His manner, I suppose, reacted on the men, for they
  • behaved to him as if nothing had occurred, as if he were still ship's
  • doctor and they still faithful hands before the mast.
  • “You're doing well, my friend,” he said to the fellow with the bandaged
  • head, “and if ever any person had a close shave, it was you; your head
  • must be as hard as iron. Well, George, how goes it? You're a pretty
  • colour, certainly; why, your liver, man, is upside down. Did you take
  • that medicine? Did he take that medicine, men?”
  • “Aye, aye, sir, he took it, sure enough,” returned Morgan.
  • “Because, you see, since I am mutineers' doctor, or prison doctor as I
  • prefer to call it,” says Doctor Livesey in his pleasantest way, “I make
  • it a point of honour not to lose a man for King George (God bless him!)
  • and the gallows.”
  • The rogues looked at each other but swallowed the home-thrust in
  • silence.
  • “Dick don't feel well, sir,” said one.
  • “Don't he?” replied the doctor. “Well, step up here, Dick, and let me
  • see your tongue. No, I should be surprised if he did! The man's tongue
  • is fit to frighten the French. Another fever.”
  • “Ah, there,” said Morgan, “that comed of sp'iling Bibles.”
  • “That comes--as you call it--of being arrant asses,” retorted the
  • doctor, “and not having sense enough to know honest air from poison,
  • and the dry land from a vile, pestiferous slough. I think it most
  • probable--though of course it's only an opinion--that you'll all have
  • the deuce to pay before you get that malaria out of your systems. Camp
  • in a bog, would you? Silver, I'm surprised at you. You're less of a fool
  • than many, take you all round; but you don't appear to me to have the
  • rudiments of a notion of the rules of health.
  • “Well,” he added after he had dosed them round and they had taken
  • his prescriptions, with really laughable humility, more like charity
  • schoolchildren than blood-guilty mutineers and pirates--“well, that's
  • done for today. And now I should wish to have a talk with that boy,
  • please.”
  • And he nodded his head in my direction carelessly.
  • George Merry was at the door, spitting and spluttering over some
  • bad-tasted medicine; but at the first word of the doctor's proposal he
  • swung round with a deep flush and cried “No!” and swore.
  • Silver struck the barrel with his open hand.
  • “Si-lence!” he roared and looked about him positively like a lion.
  • “Doctor,” he went on in his usual tones, “I was a-thinking of that,
  • knowing as how you had a fancy for the boy. We're all humbly grateful
  • for your kindness, and as you see, puts faith in you and takes the drugs
  • down like that much grog. And I take it I've found a way as'll suit all.
  • Hawkins, will you give me your word of honour as a young gentleman--for
  • a young gentleman you are, although poor born--your word of honour not
  • to slip your cable?”
  • I readily gave the pledge required.
  • “Then, doctor,” said Silver, “you just step outside o' that stockade,
  • and once you're there I'll bring the boy down on the inside, and I
  • reckon you can yarn through the spars. Good day to you, sir, and all our
  • dooties to the squire and Cap'n Smollett.”
  • The explosion of disapproval, which nothing but Silver's black looks had
  • restrained, broke out immediately the doctor had left the house. Silver
  • was roundly accused of playing double--of trying to make a separate
  • peace for himself, of sacrificing the interests of his accomplices and
  • victims, and, in one word, of the identical, exact thing that he was
  • doing. It seemed to me so obvious, in this case, that I could not
  • imagine how he was to turn their anger. But he was twice the man
  • the rest were, and his last night's victory had given him a huge
  • preponderance on their minds. He called them all the fools and dolts
  • you can imagine, said it was necessary I should talk to the doctor,
  • fluttered the chart in their faces, asked them if they could afford to
  • break the treaty the very day they were bound a-treasure-hunting.
  • “No, by thunder!” he cried. “It's us must break the treaty when the time
  • comes; and till then I'll gammon that doctor, if I have to ile his boots
  • with brandy.”
  • And then he bade them get the fire lit, and stalked out upon his crutch,
  • with his hand on my shoulder, leaving them in a disarray, and silenced
  • by his volubility rather than convinced.
  • “Slow, lad, slow,” he said. “They might round upon us in a twinkle of an
  • eye if we was seen to hurry.”
  • Very deliberately, then, did we advance across the sand to where the
  • doctor awaited us on the other side of the stockade, and as soon as we
  • were within easy speaking distance Silver stopped.
  • “You'll make a note of this here also, doctor,” says he, “and the boy'll
  • tell you how I saved his life, and were deposed for it too, and you
  • may lay to that. Doctor, when a man's steering as near the wind as
  • me--playing chuck-farthing with the last breath in his body, like--you
  • wouldn't think it too much, mayhap, to give him one good word? You'll
  • please bear in mind it's not my life only now--it's that boy's into the
  • bargain; and you'll speak me fair, doctor, and give me a bit o' hope to
  • go on, for the sake of mercy.”
  • Silver was a changed man once he was out there and had his back to his
  • friends and the block house; his cheeks seemed to have fallen in, his
  • voice trembled; never was a soul more dead in earnest.
  • “Why, John, you're not afraid?” asked Dr. Livesey.
  • “Doctor, I'm no coward; no, not I--not SO much!” and he snapped his
  • fingers. “If I was I wouldn't say it. But I'll own up fairly, I've the
  • shakes upon me for the gallows. You're a good man and a true; I never
  • seen a better man! And you'll not forget what I done good, not any more
  • than you'll forget the bad, I know. And I step aside--see here--and
  • leave you and Jim alone. And you'll put that down for me too, for it's a
  • long stretch, is that!”
  • So saying, he stepped back a little way, till he was out of earshot, and
  • there sat down upon a tree-stump and began to whistle, spinning round
  • now and again upon his seat so as to command a sight, sometimes of me
  • and the doctor and sometimes of his unruly ruffians as they went to and
  • fro in the sand between the fire--which they were busy rekindling--and
  • the house, from which they brought forth pork and bread to make the
  • breakfast.
  • “So, Jim,” said the doctor sadly, “here you are. As you have brewed, so
  • shall you drink, my boy. Heaven knows, I cannot find it in my heart to
  • blame you, but this much I will say, be it kind or unkind: when Captain
  • Smollett was well, you dared not have gone off; and when he was ill and
  • couldn't help it, by George, it was downright cowardly!”
  • I will own that I here began to weep. “Doctor,” I said, “you might spare
  • me. I have blamed myself enough; my life's forfeit anyway, and I should
  • have been dead by now if Silver hadn't stood for me; and doctor,
  • believe this, I can die--and I dare say I deserve it--but what I fear is
  • torture. If they come to torture me--”
  • “Jim,” the doctor interrupted, and his voice was quite changed, “Jim, I
  • can't have this. Whip over, and we'll run for it.”
  • “Doctor,” said I, “I passed my word.”
  • “I know, I know,” he cried. “We can't help that, Jim, now. I'll take it
  • on my shoulders, holus bolus, blame and shame, my boy; but stay here,
  • I cannot let you. Jump! One jump, and you're out, and we'll run for it
  • like antelopes.”
  • “No,” I replied; “you know right well you wouldn't do the thing
  • yourself--neither you nor squire nor captain; and no more will I. Silver
  • trusted me; I passed my word, and back I go. But, doctor, you did not
  • let me finish. If they come to torture me, I might let slip a word of
  • where the ship is, for I got the ship, part by luck and part by risking,
  • and she lies in North Inlet, on the southern beach, and just below high
  • water. At half tide she must be high and dry.”
  • “The ship!” exclaimed the doctor.
  • Rapidly I described to him my adventures, and he heard me out in
  • silence.
  • “There is a kind of fate in this,” he observed when I had done. “Every
  • step, it's you that saves our lives; and do you suppose by any chance
  • that we are going to let you lose yours? That would be a poor return, my
  • boy. You found out the plot; you found Ben Gunn--the best deed that
  • ever you did, or will do, though you live to ninety. Oh, by Jupiter, and
  • talking of Ben Gunn! Why, this is the mischief in person. Silver!” he
  • cried. “Silver! I'll give you a piece of advice,” he continued as
  • the cook drew near again; “don't you be in any great hurry after that
  • treasure.”
  • “Why, sir, I do my possible, which that ain't,” said Silver. “I can
  • only, asking your pardon, save my life and the boy's by seeking for that
  • treasure; and you may lay to that.”
  • “Well, Silver,” replied the doctor, “if that is so, I'll go one step
  • further: look out for squalls when you find it.”
  • “Sir,” said Silver, “as between man and man, that's too much and too
  • little. What you're after, why you left the block house, why you given
  • me that there chart, I don't know, now, do I? And yet I done your
  • bidding with my eyes shut and never a word of hope! But no, this here's
  • too much. If you won't tell me what you mean plain out, just say so and
  • I'll leave the helm.”
  • “No,” said the doctor musingly; “I've no right to say more; it's not my
  • secret, you see, Silver, or, I give you my word, I'd tell it you. But
  • I'll go as far with you as I dare go, and a step beyond, for I'll have
  • my wig sorted by the captain or I'm mistaken! And first, I'll give you a
  • bit of hope; Silver, if we both get alive out of this wolf-trap, I'll do
  • my best to save you, short of perjury.”
  • Silver's face was radiant. “You couldn't say more, I'm sure, sir, not if
  • you was my mother,” he cried.
  • “Well, that's my first concession,” added the doctor. “My second is a
  • piece of advice: keep the boy close beside you, and when you need help,
  • halloo. I'm off to seek it for you, and that itself will show you if I
  • speak at random. Good-bye, Jim.”
  • And Dr. Livesey shook hands with me through the stockade, nodded to
  • Silver, and set off at a brisk pace into the wood.
  • 31
  • The Treasure-hunt--Flint's Pointer
  • “JIM,” said Silver when we were alone, “if I saved your life, you saved
  • mine; and I'll not forget it. I seen the doctor waving you to run for
  • it--with the tail of my eye, I did; and I seen you say no, as plain as
  • hearing. Jim, that's one to you. This is the first glint of hope I had
  • since the attack failed, and I owe it you. And now, Jim, we're to go in
  • for this here treasure-hunting, with sealed orders too, and I don't like
  • it; and you and me must stick close, back to back like, and we'll save
  • our necks in spite o' fate and fortune.”
  • Just then a man hailed us from the fire that breakfast was ready, and
  • we were soon seated here and there about the sand over biscuit and fried
  • junk. They had lit a fire fit to roast an ox, and it was now grown so
  • hot that they could only approach it from the windward, and even there
  • not without precaution. In the same wasteful spirit, they had cooked,
  • I suppose, three times more than we could eat; and one of them, with an
  • empty laugh, threw what was left into the fire, which blazed and roared
  • again over this unusual fuel. I never in my life saw men so careless of
  • the morrow; hand to mouth is the only word that can describe their way
  • of doing; and what with wasted food and sleeping sentries, though they
  • were bold enough for a brush and be done with it, I could see their
  • entire unfitness for anything like a prolonged campaign.
  • Even Silver, eating away, with Captain Flint upon his shoulder, had not
  • a word of blame for their recklessness. And this the more surprised me,
  • for I thought he had never shown himself so cunning as he did then.
  • “Aye, mates,” said he, “it's lucky you have Barbecue to think for you
  • with this here head. I got what I wanted, I did. Sure enough, they have
  • the ship. Where they have it, I don't know yet; but once we hit the
  • treasure, we'll have to jump about and find out. And then, mates, us
  • that has the boats, I reckon, has the upper hand.”
  • Thus he kept running on, with his mouth full of the hot bacon; thus he
  • restored their hope and confidence, and, I more than suspect, repaired
  • his own at the same time.
  • “As for hostage,” he continued, “that's his last talk, I guess, with
  • them he loves so dear. I've got my piece o' news, and thanky to him
  • for that; but it's over and done. I'll take him in a line when we go
  • treasure-hunting, for we'll keep him like so much gold, in case of
  • accidents, you mark, and in the meantime. Once we got the ship and
  • treasure both and off to sea like jolly companions, why then we'll talk
  • Mr. Hawkins over, we will, and we'll give him his share, to be sure, for
  • all his kindness.”
  • It was no wonder the men were in a good humour now. For my part, I
  • was horribly cast down. Should the scheme he had now sketched prove
  • feasible, Silver, already doubly a traitor, would not hesitate to adopt
  • it. He had still a foot in either camp, and there was no doubt he
  • would prefer wealth and freedom with the pirates to a bare escape from
  • hanging, which was the best he had to hope on our side.
  • Nay, and even if things so fell out that he was forced to keep his faith
  • with Dr. Livesey, even then what danger lay before us! What a moment
  • that would be when the suspicions of his followers turned to certainty
  • and he and I should have to fight for dear life--he a cripple and I a
  • boy--against five strong and active seamen!
  • Add to this double apprehension the mystery that still hung over the
  • behaviour of my friends, their unexplained desertion of the stockade,
  • their inexplicable cession of the chart, or harder still to understand,
  • the doctor's last warning to Silver, “Look out for squalls when you
  • find it,” and you will readily believe how little taste I found in my
  • breakfast and with how uneasy a heart I set forth behind my captors on
  • the quest for treasure.
  • We made a curious figure, had anyone been there to see us--all in soiled
  • sailor clothes and all but me armed to the teeth. Silver had two guns
  • slung about him--one before and one behind--besides the great cutlass
  • at his waist and a pistol in each pocket of his square-tailed coat.
  • To complete his strange appearance, Captain Flint sat perched upon his
  • shoulder and gabbling odds and ends of purposeless sea-talk. I had a
  • line about my waist and followed obediently after the sea-cook, who
  • held the loose end of the rope, now in his free hand, now between his
  • powerful teeth. For all the world, I was led like a dancing bear.
  • The other men were variously burthened, some carrying picks and
  • shovels--for that had been the very first necessary they brought ashore
  • from the HISPANIOLA--others laden with pork, bread, and brandy for the
  • midday meal. All the stores, I observed, came from our stock, and I
  • could see the truth of Silver's words the night before. Had he not
  • struck a bargain with the doctor, he and his mutineers, deserted by the
  • ship, must have been driven to subsist on clear water and the proceeds
  • of their hunting. Water would have been little to their taste; a sailor
  • is not usually a good shot; and besides all that, when they were so
  • short of eatables, it was not likely they would be very flush of powder.
  • Well, thus equipped, we all set out--even the fellow with the broken
  • head, who should certainly have kept in shadow--and straggled, one after
  • another, to the beach, where the two gigs awaited us. Even these bore
  • trace of the drunken folly of the pirates, one in a broken thwart, and
  • both in their muddy and unbailed condition. Both were to be carried
  • along with us for the sake of safety; and so, with our numbers divided
  • between them, we set forth upon the bosom of the anchorage.
  • As we pulled over, there was some discussion on the chart. The red cross
  • was, of course, far too large to be a guide; and the terms of the note
  • on the back, as you will hear, admitted of some ambiguity. They ran, the
  • reader may remember, thus:
  • Tall tree, Spy-glass shoulder, bearing a point to
  • the N. of N.N.E.
  • Skeleton Island E.S.E. and by E.
  • Ten feet.
  • A tall tree was thus the principal mark. Now, right before us the
  • anchorage was bounded by a plateau from two to three hundred feet high,
  • adjoining on the north the sloping southern shoulder of the Spy-glass
  • and rising again towards the south into the rough, cliffy eminence
  • called the Mizzen-mast Hill. The top of the plateau was dotted thickly
  • with pine-trees of varying height. Every here and there, one of a
  • different species rose forty or fifty feet clear above its neighbours,
  • and which of these was the particular “tall tree” of Captain Flint could
  • only be decided on the spot, and by the readings of the compass.
  • Yet, although that was the case, every man on board the boats had
  • picked a favourite of his own ere we were half-way over, Long John alone
  • shrugging his shoulders and bidding them wait till they were there.
  • We pulled easily, by Silver's directions, not to weary the hands
  • prematurely, and after quite a long passage, landed at the mouth of
  • the second river--that which runs down a woody cleft of the Spy-glass.
  • Thence, bending to our left, we began to ascend the slope towards the
  • plateau.
  • At the first outset, heavy, miry ground and a matted, marish vegetation
  • greatly delayed our progress; but by little and little the hill began
  • to steepen and become stony under foot, and the wood to change its
  • character and to grow in a more open order. It was, indeed, a most
  • pleasant portion of the island that we were now approaching. A
  • heavy-scented broom and many flowering shrubs had almost taken the place
  • of grass. Thickets of green nutmeg-trees were dotted here and there with
  • the red columns and the broad shadow of the pines; and the first mingled
  • their spice with the aroma of the others. The air, besides, was fresh
  • and stirring, and this, under the sheer sunbeams, was a wonderful
  • refreshment to our senses.
  • The party spread itself abroad, in a fan shape, shouting and leaping to
  • and fro. About the centre, and a good way behind the rest, Silver and
  • I followed--I tethered by my rope, he ploughing, with deep pants, among
  • the sliding gravel. From time to time, indeed, I had to lend him a hand,
  • or he must have missed his footing and fallen backward down the hill.
  • We had thus proceeded for about half a mile and were approaching the
  • brow of the plateau when the man upon the farthest left began to cry
  • aloud, as if in terror. Shout after shout came from him, and the others
  • began to run in his direction.
  • “He can't 'a found the treasure,” said old Morgan, hurrying past us from
  • the right, “for that's clean a-top.”
  • Indeed, as we found when we also reached the spot, it was something
  • very different. At the foot of a pretty big pine and involved in a green
  • creeper, which had even partly lifted some of the smaller bones, a human
  • skeleton lay, with a few shreds of clothing, on the ground. I believe a
  • chill struck for a moment to every heart.
  • “He was a seaman,” said George Merry, who, bolder than the rest, had
  • gone up close and was examining the rags of clothing. “Leastways, this
  • is good sea-cloth.”
  • “Aye, aye,” said Silver; “like enough; you wouldn't look to find a
  • bishop here, I reckon. But what sort of a way is that for bones to lie?
  • 'Tain't in natur'.”
  • Indeed, on a second glance, it seemed impossible to fancy that the body
  • was in a natural position. But for some disarray (the work, perhaps, of
  • the birds that had fed upon him or of the slow-growing creeper that had
  • gradually enveloped his remains) the man lay perfectly straight--his
  • feet pointing in one direction, his hands, raised above his head like a
  • diver's, pointing directly in the opposite.
  • “I've taken a notion into my old numbskull,” observed Silver. “Here's
  • the compass; there's the tip-top p'int o' Skeleton Island, stickin'
  • out like a tooth. Just take a bearing, will you, along the line of them
  • bones.”
  • It was done. The body pointed straight in the direction of the island,
  • and the compass read duly E.S.E. and by E.
  • “I thought so,” cried the cook; “this here is a p'inter. Right up there
  • is our line for the Pole Star and the jolly dollars. But, by thunder!
  • If it don't make me cold inside to think of Flint. This is one of HIS
  • jokes, and no mistake. Him and these six was alone here; he killed 'em,
  • every man; and this one he hauled here and laid down by compass, shiver
  • my timbers! They're long bones, and the hair's been yellow. Aye, that
  • would be Allardyce. You mind Allardyce, Tom Morgan?”
  • “Aye, aye,” returned Morgan; “I mind him; he owed me money, he did, and
  • took my knife ashore with him.”
  • “Speaking of knives,” said another, “why don't we find his'n lying
  • round? Flint warn't the man to pick a seaman's pocket; and the birds, I
  • guess, would leave it be.”
  • “By the powers, and that's true!” cried Silver.
  • “There ain't a thing left here,” said Merry, still feeling round among
  • the bones; “not a copper doit nor a baccy box. It don't look nat'ral to
  • me.”
  • “No, by gum, it don't,” agreed Silver; “not nat'ral, nor not nice, says
  • you. Great guns! Messmates, but if Flint was living, this would be a hot
  • spot for you and me. Six they were, and six are we; and bones is what
  • they are now.”
  • “I saw him dead with these here deadlights,” said Morgan. “Billy took me
  • in. There he laid, with penny-pieces on his eyes.”
  • “Dead--aye, sure enough he's dead and gone below,” said the fellow with
  • the bandage; “but if ever sperrit walked, it would be Flint's. Dear
  • heart, but he died bad, did Flint!”
  • “Aye, that he did,” observed another; “now he raged, and now he hollered
  • for the rum, and now he sang. 'Fifteen Men' were his only song, mates;
  • and I tell you true, I never rightly liked to hear it since. It was
  • main hot, and the windy was open, and I hear that old song comin' out as
  • clear as clear--and the death-haul on the man already.”
  • “Come, come,” said Silver; “stow this talk. He's dead, and he don't
  • walk, that I know; leastways, he won't walk by day, and you may lay to
  • that. Care killed a cat. Fetch ahead for the doubloons.”
  • We started, certainly; but in spite of the hot sun and the staring
  • daylight, the pirates no longer ran separate and shouting through the
  • wood, but kept side by side and spoke with bated breath. The terror of
  • the dead buccaneer had fallen on their spirits.
  • 32
  • The Treasure-hunt--The Voice Among the Trees
  • PARTLY from the damping influence of this alarm, partly to rest Silver
  • and the sick folk, the whole party sat down as soon as they had gained
  • the brow of the ascent.
  • The plateau being somewhat tilted towards the west, this spot on which
  • we had paused commanded a wide prospect on either hand. Before us,
  • over the tree-tops, we beheld the Cape of the Woods fringed with surf;
  • behind, we not only looked down upon the anchorage and Skeleton Island,
  • but saw--clear across the spit and the eastern lowlands--a great field
  • of open sea upon the east. Sheer above us rose the Spyglass, here dotted
  • with single pines, there black with precipices. There was no sound but
  • that of the distant breakers, mounting from all round, and the chirp of
  • countless insects in the brush. Not a man, not a sail, upon the sea; the
  • very largeness of the view increased the sense of solitude.
  • Silver, as he sat, took certain bearings with his compass.
  • “There are three 'tall trees'” said he, “about in the right line from
  • Skeleton Island. 'Spy-glass shoulder,' I take it, means that lower p'int
  • there. It's child's play to find the stuff now. I've half a mind to dine
  • first.”
  • “I don't feel sharp,” growled Morgan. “Thinkin' o' Flint--I think it
  • were--as done me.”
  • “Ah, well, my son, you praise your stars he's dead,” said Silver.
  • “He were an ugly devil,” cried a third pirate with a shudder; “that blue
  • in the face too!”
  • “That was how the rum took him,” added Merry. “Blue! Well, I reckon he
  • was blue. That's a true word.”
  • Ever since they had found the skeleton and got upon this train of
  • thought, they had spoken lower and lower, and they had almost got to
  • whispering by now, so that the sound of their talk hardly interrupted
  • the silence of the wood. All of a sudden, out of the middle of the trees
  • in front of us, a thin, high, trembling voice struck up the well-known
  • air and words:
  • “Fifteen men on the dead man's chest--
  • Yo-ho-ho, and a bottle of rum!”
  • I never have seen men more dreadfully affected than the pirates. The
  • colour went from their six faces like enchantment; some leaped to their
  • feet, some clawed hold of others; Morgan grovelled on the ground.
  • “It's Flint, by ----!” cried Merry.
  • The song had stopped as suddenly as it began--broken off, you would have
  • said, in the middle of a note, as though someone had laid his hand upon
  • the singer's mouth. Coming through the clear, sunny atmosphere among the
  • green tree-tops, I thought it had sounded airily and sweetly; and the
  • effect on my companions was the stranger.
  • “Come,” said Silver, struggling with his ashen lips to get the word out;
  • “this won't do. Stand by to go about. This is a rum start, and I can't
  • name the voice, but it's someone skylarking--someone that's flesh and
  • blood, and you may lay to that.”
  • His courage had come back as he spoke, and some of the colour to his
  • face along with it. Already the others had begun to lend an ear to this
  • encouragement and were coming a little to themselves, when the same
  • voice broke out again--not this time singing, but in a faint distant
  • hail that echoed yet fainter among the clefts of the Spy-glass.
  • “Darby M'Graw,” it wailed--for that is the word that best describes the
  • sound--“Darby M'Graw! Darby M'Graw!” again and again and again; and then
  • rising a little higher, and with an oath that I leave out: “Fetch aft
  • the rum, Darby!”
  • The buccaneers remained rooted to the ground, their eyes starting from
  • their heads. Long after the voice had died away they still stared in
  • silence, dreadfully, before them.
  • “That fixes it!” gasped one. “Let's go.”
  • “They was his last words,” moaned Morgan, “his last words above board.”
  • Dick had his Bible out and was praying volubly. He had been well brought
  • up, had Dick, before he came to sea and fell among bad companions.
  • Still Silver was unconquered. I could hear his teeth rattle in his head,
  • but he had not yet surrendered.
  • “Nobody in this here island ever heard of Darby,” he muttered; “not one
  • but us that's here.” And then, making a great effort: “Shipmates,”
  • he cried, “I'm here to get that stuff, and I'll not be beat by man or
  • devil. I never was feared of Flint in his life, and, by the powers, I'll
  • face him dead. There's seven hundred thousand pound not a quarter of a
  • mile from here. When did ever a gentleman o' fortune show his stern to
  • that much dollars for a boozy old seaman with a blue mug--and him dead
  • too?”
  • But there was no sign of reawakening courage in his followers, rather,
  • indeed, of growing terror at the irreverence of his words.
  • “Belay there, John!” said Merry. “Don't you cross a sperrit.”
  • And the rest were all too terrified to reply. They would have run away
  • severally had they dared; but fear kept them together, and kept them
  • close by John, as if his daring helped them. He, on his part, had pretty
  • well fought his weakness down.
  • “Sperrit? Well, maybe,” he said. “But there's one thing not clear to me.
  • There was an echo. Now, no man ever seen a sperrit with a shadow; well
  • then, what's he doing with an echo to him, I should like to know? That
  • ain't in natur', surely?”
  • This argument seemed weak enough to me. But you can never tell what will
  • affect the superstitious, and to my wonder, George Merry was greatly
  • relieved.
  • “Well, that's so,” he said. “You've a head upon your shoulders, John,
  • and no mistake. 'Bout ship, mates! This here crew is on a wrong tack, I
  • do believe. And come to think on it, it was like Flint's voice, I
  • grant you, but not just so clear-away like it, after all. It was liker
  • somebody else's voice now--it was liker--”
  • “By the powers, Ben Gunn!” roared Silver.
  • “Aye, and so it were,” cried Morgan, springing on his knees. “Ben Gunn
  • it were!”
  • “It don't make much odds, do it, now?” asked Dick. “Ben Gunn's not here
  • in the body any more'n Flint.”
  • But the older hands greeted this remark with scorn.
  • “Why, nobody minds Ben Gunn,” cried Merry; “dead or alive, nobody minds
  • him.”
  • It was extraordinary how their spirits had returned and how the natural
  • colour had revived in their faces. Soon they were chatting together,
  • with intervals of listening; and not long after, hearing no further
  • sound, they shouldered the tools and set forth again, Merry walking
  • first with Silver's compass to keep them on the right line with Skeleton
  • Island. He had said the truth: dead or alive, nobody minded Ben Gunn.
  • Dick alone still held his Bible, and looked around him as he went, with
  • fearful glances; but he found no sympathy, and Silver even joked him on
  • his precautions.
  • “I told you,” said he--“I told you you had sp'iled your Bible. If it
  • ain't no good to swear by, what do you suppose a sperrit would give for
  • it? Not that!” and he snapped his big fingers, halting a moment on his
  • crutch.
  • But Dick was not to be comforted; indeed, it was soon plain to me that
  • the lad was falling sick; hastened by heat, exhaustion, and the shock
  • of his alarm, the fever, predicted by Dr. Livesey, was evidently growing
  • swiftly higher.
  • It was fine open walking here, upon the summit; our way lay a little
  • downhill, for, as I have said, the plateau tilted towards the west. The
  • pines, great and small, grew wide apart; and even between the clumps of
  • nutmeg and azalea, wide open spaces baked in the hot sunshine. Striking,
  • as we did, pretty near north-west across the island, we drew, on the
  • one hand, ever nearer under the shoulders of the Spy-glass, and on the
  • other, looked ever wider over that western bay where I had once tossed
  • and trembled in the coracle.
  • The first of the tall trees was reached, and by the bearings proved the
  • wrong one. So with the second. The third rose nearly two hundred feet
  • into the air above a clump of underwood--a giant of a vegetable, with
  • a red column as big as a cottage, and a wide shadow around in which a
  • company could have manoeuvred. It was conspicuous far to sea both on
  • the east and west and might have been entered as a sailing mark upon the
  • chart.
  • But it was not its size that now impressed my companions; it was the
  • knowledge that seven hundred thousand pounds in gold lay somewhere
  • buried below its spreading shadow. The thought of the money, as they
  • drew nearer, swallowed up their previous terrors. Their eyes burned in
  • their heads; their feet grew speedier and lighter; their whole soul
  • was bound up in that fortune, that whole lifetime of extravagance and
  • pleasure, that lay waiting there for each of them.
  • Silver hobbled, grunting, on his crutch; his nostrils stood out and
  • quivered; he cursed like a madman when the flies settled on his hot and
  • shiny countenance; he plucked furiously at the line that held me to
  • him and from time to time turned his eyes upon me with a deadly look.
  • Certainly he took no pains to hide his thoughts, and certainly I read
  • them like print. In the immediate nearness of the gold, all else had
  • been forgotten: his promise and the doctor's warning were both things
  • of the past, and I could not doubt that he hoped to seize upon the
  • treasure, find and board the HISPANIOLA under cover of night, cut
  • every honest throat about that island, and sail away as he had at first
  • intended, laden with crimes and riches.
  • Shaken as I was with these alarms, it was hard for me to keep up with
  • the rapid pace of the treasure-hunters. Now and again I stumbled, and it
  • was then that Silver plucked so roughly at the rope and launched at me
  • his murderous glances. Dick, who had dropped behind us and now brought
  • up the rear, was babbling to himself both prayers and curses as his
  • fever kept rising. This also added to my wretchedness, and to crown all,
  • I was haunted by the thought of the tragedy that had once been acted
  • on that plateau, when that ungodly buccaneer with the blue face--he who
  • died at Savannah, singing and shouting for drink--had there, with his
  • own hand, cut down his six accomplices. This grove that was now so
  • peaceful must then have rung with cries, I thought; and even with the
  • thought I could believe I heard it ringing still.
  • We were now at the margin of the thicket.
  • “Huzza, mates, all together!” shouted Merry; and the foremost broke into
  • a run.
  • And suddenly, not ten yards further, we beheld them stop. A low cry
  • arose. Silver doubled his pace, digging away with the foot of his crutch
  • like one possessed; and next moment he and I had come also to a dead
  • halt.
  • Before us was a great excavation, not very recent, for the sides had
  • fallen in and grass had sprouted on the bottom. In this were the shaft
  • of a pick broken in two and the boards of several packing-cases strewn
  • around. On one of these boards I saw, branded with a hot iron, the name
  • WALRUS--the name of Flint's ship.
  • All was clear to probation. The CACHE had been found and rifled; the
  • seven hundred thousand pounds were gone!
  • 33
  • The Fall of a Chieftain
  • THERE never was such an overturn in this world. Each of these six men
  • was as though he had been struck. But with Silver the blow passed almost
  • instantly. Every thought of his soul had been set full-stretch, like a
  • racer, on that money; well, he was brought up, in a single second, dead;
  • and he kept his head, found his temper, and changed his plan before the
  • others had had time to realize the disappointment.
  • “Jim,” he whispered, “take that, and stand by for trouble.”
  • And he passed me a double-barrelled pistol.
  • At the same time, he began quietly moving northward, and in a few steps
  • had put the hollow between us two and the other five. Then he looked at
  • me and nodded, as much as to say, “Here is a narrow corner,” as, indeed,
  • I thought it was. His looks were not quite friendly, and I was so
  • revolted at these constant changes that I could not forbear whispering,
  • “So you've changed sides again.”
  • There was no time left for him to answer in. The buccaneers, with oaths
  • and cries, began to leap, one after another, into the pit and to dig
  • with their fingers, throwing the boards aside as they did so. Morgan
  • found a piece of gold. He held it up with a perfect spout of oaths. It
  • was a two-guinea piece, and it went from hand to hand among them for a
  • quarter of a minute.
  • “Two guineas!” roared Merry, shaking it at Silver. “That's your seven
  • hundred thousand pounds, is it? You're the man for bargains, ain't you?
  • You're him that never bungled nothing, you wooden-headed lubber!”
  • “Dig away, boys,” said Silver with the coolest insolence; “you'll find
  • some pig-nuts and I shouldn't wonder.”
  • “Pig-nuts!” repeated Merry, in a scream. “Mates, do you hear that? I
  • tell you now, that man there knew it all along. Look in the face of him
  • and you'll see it wrote there.”
  • “Ah, Merry,” remarked Silver, “standing for cap'n again? You're a
  • pushing lad, to be sure.”
  • But this time everyone was entirely in Merry's favour. They began to
  • scramble out of the excavation, darting furious glances behind them. One
  • thing I observed, which looked well for us: they all got out upon the
  • opposite side from Silver.
  • Well, there we stood, two on one side, five on the other, the pit
  • between us, and nobody screwed up high enough to offer the first blow.
  • Silver never moved; he watched them, very upright on his crutch, and
  • looked as cool as ever I saw him. He was brave, and no mistake.
  • At last Merry seemed to think a speech might help matters.
  • “Mates,” says he, “there's two of them alone there; one's the old
  • cripple that brought us all here and blundered us down to this; the
  • other's that cub that I mean to have the heart of. Now, mates--”
  • He was raising his arm and his voice, and plainly meant to lead a
  • charge. But just then--crack! crack! crack!--three musket-shots flashed
  • out of the thicket. Merry tumbled head foremost into the excavation; the
  • man with the bandage spun round like a teetotum and fell all his length
  • upon his side, where he lay dead, but still twitching; and the other
  • three turned and ran for it with all their might.
  • Before you could wink, Long John had fired two barrels of a pistol into
  • the struggling Merry, and as the man rolled up his eyes at him in the
  • last agony, “George,” said he, “I reckon I settled you.”
  • At the same moment, the doctor, Gray, and Ben Gunn joined us, with
  • smoking muskets, from among the nutmeg-trees.
  • “Forward!” cried the doctor. “Double quick, my lads. We must head 'em
  • off the boats.”
  • And we set off at a great pace, sometimes plunging through the bushes to
  • the chest.
  • I tell you, but Silver was anxious to keep up with us. The work that man
  • went through, leaping on his crutch till the muscles of his chest were
  • fit to burst, was work no sound man ever equalled; and so thinks the
  • doctor. As it was, he was already thirty yards behind us and on the
  • verge of strangling when we reached the brow of the slope.
  • “Doctor,” he hailed, “see there! No hurry!”
  • Sure enough there was no hurry. In a more open part of the plateau, we
  • could see the three survivors still running in the same direction as
  • they had started, right for Mizzenmast Hill. We were already between
  • them and the boats; and so we four sat down to breathe, while Long John,
  • mopping his face, came slowly up with us.
  • “Thank ye kindly, doctor,” says he. “You came in in about the nick, I
  • guess, for me and Hawkins. And so it's you, Ben Gunn!” he added. “Well,
  • you're a nice one, to be sure.”
  • “I'm Ben Gunn, I am,” replied the maroon, wriggling like an eel in his
  • embarrassment. “And,” he added, after a long pause, “how do, Mr. Silver?
  • Pretty well, I thank ye, says you.”
  • “Ben, Ben,” murmured Silver, “to think as you've done me!”
  • The doctor sent back Gray for one of the pick-axes deserted, in their
  • flight, by the mutineers, and then as we proceeded leisurely downhill to
  • where the boats were lying, related in a few words what had taken place.
  • It was a story that profoundly interested Silver; and Ben Gunn, the
  • half-idiot maroon, was the hero from beginning to end.
  • Ben, in his long, lonely wanderings about the island, had found the
  • skeleton--it was he that had rifled it; he had found the treasure; he
  • had dug it up (it was the haft of his pick-axe that lay broken in the
  • excavation); he had carried it on his back, in many weary journeys, from
  • the foot of the tall pine to a cave he had on the two-pointed hill at
  • the north-east angle of the island, and there it had lain stored in
  • safety since two months before the arrival of the HISPANIOLA.
  • When the doctor had wormed this secret from him on the afternoon of the
  • attack, and when next morning he saw the anchorage deserted, he had gone
  • to Silver, given him the chart, which was now useless--given him the
  • stores, for Ben Gunn's cave was well supplied with goats' meat salted
  • by himself--given anything and everything to get a chance of moving in
  • safety from the stockade to the two-pointed hill, there to be clear of
  • malaria and keep a guard upon the money.
  • “As for you, Jim,” he said, “it went against my heart, but I did what I
  • thought best for those who had stood by their duty; and if you were not
  • one of these, whose fault was it?”
  • That morning, finding that I was to be involved in the horrid
  • disappointment he had prepared for the mutineers, he had run all the way
  • to the cave, and leaving the squire to guard the captain, had taken Gray
  • and the maroon and started, making the diagonal across the island to be
  • at hand beside the pine. Soon, however, he saw that our party had the
  • start of him; and Ben Gunn, being fleet of foot, had been dispatched in
  • front to do his best alone. Then it had occurred to him to work upon the
  • superstitions of his former shipmates, and he was so far successful that
  • Gray and the doctor had come up and were already ambushed before the
  • arrival of the treasure-hunters.
  • “Ah,” said Silver, “it were fortunate for me that I had Hawkins here.
  • You would have let old John be cut to bits, and never given it a
  • thought, doctor.”
  • “Not a thought,” replied Dr. Livesey cheerily.
  • And by this time we had reached the gigs. The doctor, with the pick-axe,
  • demolished one of them, and then we all got aboard the other and set out
  • to go round by sea for North Inlet.
  • This was a run of eight or nine miles. Silver, though he was almost
  • killed already with fatigue, was set to an oar, like the rest of us, and
  • we were soon skimming swiftly over a smooth sea. Soon we passed out
  • of the straits and doubled the south-east corner of the island, round
  • which, four days ago, we had towed the HISPANIOLA.
  • As we passed the two-pointed hill, we could see the black mouth of Ben
  • Gunn's cave and a figure standing by it, leaning on a musket. It was the
  • squire, and we waved a handkerchief and gave him three cheers, in which
  • the voice of Silver joined as heartily as any.
  • Three miles farther, just inside the mouth of North Inlet, what should
  • we meet but the HISPANIOLA, cruising by herself? The last flood had
  • lifted her, and had there been much wind or a strong tide current, as
  • in the southern anchorage, we should never have found her more, or found
  • her stranded beyond help. As it was, there was little amiss beyond the
  • wreck of the main-sail. Another anchor was got ready and dropped in a
  • fathom and a half of water. We all pulled round again to Rum Cove,
  • the nearest point for Ben Gunn's treasure-house; and then Gray,
  • single-handed, returned with the gig to the HISPANIOLA, where he was to
  • pass the night on guard.
  • A gentle slope ran up from the beach to the entrance of the cave. At the
  • top, the squire met us. To me he was cordial and kind, saying nothing
  • of my escapade either in the way of blame or praise. At Silver's polite
  • salute he somewhat flushed.
  • “John Silver,” he said, “you're a prodigious villain and imposter--a
  • monstrous imposter, sir. I am told I am not to prosecute you. Well,
  • then, I will not. But the dead men, sir, hang about your neck like
  • mill-stones.”
  • “Thank you kindly, sir,” replied Long John, again saluting.
  • “I dare you to thank me!” cried the squire. “It is a gross dereliction
  • of my duty. Stand back.”
  • And thereupon we all entered the cave. It was a large, airy place, with
  • a little spring and a pool of clear water, overhung with ferns. The
  • floor was sand. Before a big fire lay Captain Smollett; and in a far
  • corner, only duskily flickered over by the blaze, I beheld great heaps
  • of coin and quadrilaterals built of bars of gold. That was Flint's
  • treasure that we had come so far to seek and that had cost already the
  • lives of seventeen men from the HISPANIOLA. How many it had cost in the
  • amassing, what blood and sorrow, what good ships scuttled on the deep,
  • what brave men walking the plank blindfold, what shot of cannon, what
  • shame and lies and cruelty, perhaps no man alive could tell. Yet there
  • were still three upon that island--Silver, and old Morgan, and Ben
  • Gunn--who had each taken his share in these crimes, as each had hoped in
  • vain to share in the reward.
  • “Come in, Jim,” said the captain. “You're a good boy in your line, Jim,
  • but I don't think you and me'll go to sea again. You're too much of the
  • born favourite for me. Is that you, John Silver? What brings you here,
  • man?”
  • “Come back to my dooty, sir,” returned Silver.
  • “Ah!” said the captain, and that was all he said.
  • What a supper I had of it that night, with all my friends around me; and
  • what a meal it was, with Ben Gunn's salted goat and some delicacies and
  • a bottle of old wine from the HISPANIOLA. Never, I am sure, were people
  • gayer or happier. And there was Silver, sitting back almost out of the
  • firelight, but eating heartily, prompt to spring forward when anything
  • was wanted, even joining quietly in our laughter--the same bland,
  • polite, obsequious seaman of the voyage out.
  • 34
  • And Last
  • THE next morning we fell early to work, for the transportation of this
  • great mass of gold near a mile by land to the beach, and thence three
  • miles by boat to the HISPANIOLA, was a considerable task for so small
  • a number of workmen. The three fellows still abroad upon the island did
  • not greatly trouble us; a single sentry on the shoulder of the hill was
  • sufficient to ensure us against any sudden onslaught, and we thought,
  • besides, they had had more than enough of fighting.
  • Therefore the work was pushed on briskly. Gray and Ben Gunn came and
  • went with the boat, while the rest during their absences piled treasure
  • on the beach. Two of the bars, slung in a rope's end, made a good load
  • for a grown man--one that he was glad to walk slowly with. For my part,
  • as I was not much use at carrying, I was kept busy all day in the cave
  • packing the minted money into bread-bags.
  • It was a strange collection, like Billy Bones's hoard for the diversity
  • of coinage, but so much larger and so much more varied that I think I
  • never had more pleasure than in sorting them. English, French, Spanish,
  • Portuguese, Georges, and Louises, doubloons and double guineas and
  • moidores and sequins, the pictures of all the kings of Europe for the
  • last hundred years, strange Oriental pieces stamped with what looked
  • like wisps of string or bits of spider's web, round pieces and square
  • pieces, and pieces bored through the middle, as if to wear them round
  • your neck--nearly every variety of money in the world must, I think,
  • have found a place in that collection; and for number, I am sure they
  • were like autumn leaves, so that my back ached with stooping and my
  • fingers with sorting them out.
  • Day after day this work went on; by every evening a fortune had been
  • stowed aboard, but there was another fortune waiting for the morrow; and
  • all this time we heard nothing of the three surviving mutineers.
  • At last--I think it was on the third night--the doctor and I were
  • strolling on the shoulder of the hill where it overlooks the lowlands of
  • the isle, when, from out the thick darkness below, the wind brought us
  • a noise between shrieking and singing. It was only a snatch that reached
  • our ears, followed by the former silence.
  • “Heaven forgive them,” said the doctor; “'tis the mutineers!”
  • “All drunk, sir,” struck in the voice of Silver from behind us.
  • Silver, I should say, was allowed his entire liberty, and in spite of
  • daily rebuffs, seemed to regard himself once more as quite a privileged
  • and friendly dependent. Indeed, it was remarkable how well he bore
  • these slights and with what unwearying politeness he kept on trying to
  • ingratiate himself with all. Yet, I think, none treated him better than
  • a dog, unless it was Ben Gunn, who was still terribly afraid of his old
  • quartermaster, or myself, who had really something to thank him for;
  • although for that matter, I suppose, I had reason to think even worse of
  • him than anybody else, for I had seen him meditating a fresh treachery
  • upon the plateau. Accordingly, it was pretty gruffly that the doctor
  • answered him.
  • “Drunk or raving,” said he.
  • “Right you were, sir,” replied Silver; “and precious little odds which,
  • to you and me.”
  • “I suppose you would hardly ask me to call you a humane man,” returned
  • the doctor with a sneer, “and so my feelings may surprise you, Master
  • Silver. But if I were sure they were raving--as I am morally certain
  • one, at least, of them is down with fever--I should leave this camp,
  • and at whatever risk to my own carcass, take them the assistance of my
  • skill.”
  • “Ask your pardon, sir, you would be very wrong,” quoth Silver. “You
  • would lose your precious life, and you may lay to that. I'm on your side
  • now, hand and glove; and I shouldn't wish for to see the party weakened,
  • let alone yourself, seeing as I know what I owes you. But these men down
  • there, they couldn't keep their word--no, not supposing they wished to;
  • and what's more, they couldn't believe as you could.”
  • “No,” said the doctor. “You're the man to keep your word, we know that.”
  • Well, that was about the last news we had of the three pirates. Only
  • once we heard a gunshot a great way off and supposed them to be hunting.
  • A council was held, and it was decided that we must desert them on the
  • island--to the huge glee, I must say, of Ben Gunn, and with the strong
  • approval of Gray. We left a good stock of powder and shot, the bulk
  • of the salt goat, a few medicines, and some other necessaries, tools,
  • clothing, a spare sail, a fathom or two of rope, and by the particular
  • desire of the doctor, a handsome present of tobacco.
  • That was about our last doing on the island. Before that, we had got the
  • treasure stowed and had shipped enough water and the remainder of the
  • goat meat in case of any distress; and at last, one fine morning, we
  • weighed anchor, which was about all that we could manage, and stood out
  • of North Inlet, the same colours flying that the captain had flown and
  • fought under at the palisade.
  • The three fellows must have been watching us closer than we thought for,
  • as we soon had proved. For coming through the narrows, we had to
  • lie very near the southern point, and there we saw all three of
  • them kneeling together on a spit of sand, with their arms raised in
  • supplication. It went to all our hearts, I think, to leave them in that
  • wretched state; but we could not risk another mutiny; and to take them
  • home for the gibbet would have been a cruel sort of kindness. The doctor
  • hailed them and told them of the stores we had left, and where they were
  • to find them. But they continued to call us by name and appeal to us,
  • for God's sake, to be merciful and not leave them to die in such a
  • place.
  • At last, seeing the ship still bore on her course and was now swiftly
  • drawing out of earshot, one of them--I know not which it was--leapt to
  • his feet with a hoarse cry, whipped his musket to his shoulder, and sent
  • a shot whistling over Silver's head and through the main-sail.
  • After that, we kept under cover of the bulwarks, and when next I looked
  • out they had disappeared from the spit, and the spit itself had almost
  • melted out of sight in the growing distance. That was, at least, the end
  • of that; and before noon, to my inexpressible joy, the highest rock of
  • Treasure Island had sunk into the blue round of sea.
  • We were so short of men that everyone on board had to bear a hand--only
  • the captain lying on a mattress in the stern and giving his orders, for
  • though greatly recovered he was still in want of quiet. We laid her
  • head for the nearest port in Spanish America, for we could not risk the
  • voyage home without fresh hands; and as it was, what with baffling winds
  • and a couple of fresh gales, we were all worn out before we reached it.
  • It was just at sundown when we cast anchor in a most beautiful
  • land-locked gulf, and were immediately surrounded by shore boats full
  • of Negroes and Mexican Indians and half-bloods selling fruits and
  • vegetables and offering to dive for bits of money. The sight of so many
  • good-humoured faces (especially the blacks), the taste of the tropical
  • fruits, and above all the lights that began to shine in the town made a
  • most charming contrast to our dark and bloody sojourn on the island;
  • and the doctor and the squire, taking me along with them, went ashore
  • to pass the early part of the night. Here they met the captain of an
  • English man-of-war, fell in talk with him, went on board his ship, and,
  • in short, had so agreeable a time that day was breaking when we came
  • alongside the HISPANIOLA.
  • Ben Gunn was on deck alone, and as soon as we came on board he began,
  • with wonderful contortions, to make us a confession. Silver was gone.
  • The maroon had connived at his escape in a shore boat some hours ago,
  • and he now assured us he had only done so to preserve our lives, which
  • would certainly have been forfeit if “that man with the one leg
  • had stayed aboard.” But this was not all. The sea-cook had not gone
  • empty-handed. He had cut through a bulkhead unobserved and had removed
  • one of the sacks of coin, worth perhaps three or four hundred guineas,
  • to help him on his further wanderings.
  • I think we were all pleased to be so cheaply quit of him.
  • Well, to make a long story short, we got a few hands on board, made a
  • good cruise home, and the HISPANIOLA reached Bristol just as Mr. Blandly
  • was beginning to think of fitting out her consort. Five men only of
  • those who had sailed returned with her. “Drink and the devil had done
  • for the rest,” with a vengeance, although, to be sure, we were not quite
  • in so bad a case as that other ship they sang about:
  • With one man of her crew alive,
  • What put to sea with seventy-five.
  • All of us had an ample share of the treasure and used it wisely or
  • foolishly, according to our natures. Captain Smollett is now retired
  • from the sea. Gray not only saved his money, but being suddenly smit
  • with the desire to rise, also studied his profession, and he is now
  • mate and part owner of a fine full-rigged ship, married besides, and the
  • father of a family. As for Ben Gunn, he got a thousand pounds, which he
  • spent or lost in three weeks, or to be more exact, in nineteen days, for
  • he was back begging on the twentieth. Then he was given a lodge to keep,
  • exactly as he had feared upon the island; and he still lives, a great
  • favourite, though something of a butt, with the country boys, and a
  • notable singer in church on Sundays and saints' days.
  • Of Silver we have heard no more. That formidable seafaring man with one
  • leg has at last gone clean out of my life; but I dare say he met his old
  • Negress, and perhaps still lives in comfort with her and Captain Flint.
  • It is to be hoped so, I suppose, for his chances of comfort in another
  • world are very small.
  • The bar silver and the arms still lie, for all that I know, where
  • Flint buried them; and certainly they shall lie there for me. Oxen and
  • wain-ropes would not bring me back again to that accursed island; and
  • the worst dreams that ever I have are when I hear the surf booming about
  • its coasts or start upright in bed with the sharp voice of Captain Flint
  • still ringing in my ears: “Pieces of eight! Pieces of eight!”
  • End of Project Gutenberg's Treasure Island, by Robert Louis Stevenson
  • *** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TREASURE ISLAND ***
  • ***** This file should be named 120-0.txt or 120-0.zip *****
  • This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
  • http://www.gutenberg.org/1/2/120/
  • Produced by Judy Boss, John Hamm and David Widger
  • Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
  • will be renamed.
  • Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
  • one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
  • (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
  • permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
  • set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
  • copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
  • protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
  • Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
  • charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
  • do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
  • rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
  • such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
  • research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
  • practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
  • subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
  • redistribution.
  • *** START: FULL LICENSE ***
  • THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
  • PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
  • To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
  • distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
  • (or any other work associated in any way with the phrase “Project
  • Gutenberg”), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
  • Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
  • http://gutenberg.org/license).
  • Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
  • electronic works
  • 1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
  • electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
  • and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
  • (trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
  • the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
  • all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
  • If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
  • Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
  • terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
  • entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
  • 1.B. “Project Gutenberg” is a registered trademark. It may only be
  • used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
  • agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
  • things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
  • even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
  • paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
  • Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
  • and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
  • works. See paragraph 1.E below.
  • 1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (“the Foundation”
  • or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
  • Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
  • collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
  • individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
  • located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
  • copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
  • works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
  • are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
  • Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
  • freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
  • this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
  • the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
  • keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
  • Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
  • 1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
  • what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
  • a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
  • the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
  • before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
  • creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
  • Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
  • the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
  • States.
  • 1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
  • 1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
  • access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
  • whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
  • phrase “Project Gutenberg” appears, or with which the phrase “Project
  • Gutenberg” is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
  • copied or distributed:
  • This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
  • almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
  • re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
  • with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
  • 1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
  • from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
  • posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
  • and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
  • or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
  • with the phrase “Project Gutenberg” associated with or appearing on the
  • work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
  • through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
  • Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
  • 1.E.9.
  • 1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
  • with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
  • must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
  • terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
  • to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
  • permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
  • 1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
  • License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
  • work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
  • 1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
  • electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
  • prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
  • active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
  • Gutenberg-tm License.
  • 1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
  • compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
  • word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
  • distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
  • “Plain Vanilla ASCII” or other format used in the official version
  • posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
  • you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
  • copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
  • request, of the work in its original “Plain Vanilla ASCII” or other
  • form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
  • License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
  • 1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
  • performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
  • unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
  • 1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
  • access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
  • that
  • - You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
  • the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
  • you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
  • owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
  • has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
  • Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
  • must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
  • prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
  • returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
  • sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
  • address specified in Section 4, “Information about donations to
  • the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation.”
  • - You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
  • you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
  • does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
  • License. You must require such a user to return or
  • destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
  • and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
  • Project Gutenberg-tm works.
  • - You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
  • money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
  • electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
  • of receipt of the work.
  • - You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
  • distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
  • 1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
  • electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
  • forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
  • both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
  • Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
  • Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
  • 1.F.
  • 1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
  • effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
  • public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
  • collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
  • works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
  • “Defects,” such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
  • corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
  • property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
  • computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
  • your equipment.
  • 1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the “Right
  • of Replacement or Refund” described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
  • Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
  • Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
  • Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
  • liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
  • fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
  • LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
  • PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
  • TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
  • LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
  • INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
  • DAMAGE.
  • 1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
  • defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
  • receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
  • written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
  • received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
  • your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
  • the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
  • refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
  • providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
  • receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
  • is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
  • opportunities to fix the problem.
  • 1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
  • in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
  • WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
  • WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
  • 1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
  • warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
  • If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
  • law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
  • interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
  • the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
  • provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
  • 1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
  • trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
  • providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
  • with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
  • promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
  • harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
  • that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
  • or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
  • work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
  • Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
  • Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
  • Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
  • electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
  • including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
  • because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
  • people in all walks of life.
  • Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
  • assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
  • goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
  • remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
  • Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
  • and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
  • To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
  • and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
  • and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
  • Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
  • Foundation
  • The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
  • 501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
  • state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
  • Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
  • number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
  • http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
  • Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
  • permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
  • The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
  • Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
  • throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
  • 809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
  • business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
  • information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
  • page at http://pglaf.org
  • For additional contact information:
  • Dr. Gregory B. Newby
  • Chief Executive and Director
  • gbnewby@pglaf.org
  • Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
  • Literary Archive Foundation
  • Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
  • spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
  • increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
  • freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
  • array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
  • ($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
  • status with the IRS.
  • The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
  • charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
  • States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
  • considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
  • with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
  • where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
  • SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
  • particular state visit http://pglaf.org
  • While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
  • have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
  • against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
  • approach us with offers to donate.
  • International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
  • any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
  • outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
  • Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
  • methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
  • ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
  • To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
  • Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
  • works.
  • Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
  • concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
  • with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
  • Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
  • Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
  • editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
  • unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
  • keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
  • Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
  • http://www.gutenberg.org
  • This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
  • including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
  • Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
  • subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.